blob: f0beacfe1014a6139acb62de967fe87374cc8eb5 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000249
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000250 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000259 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000260 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 }
262
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000269
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000282
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000298 return &I;
299 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000301
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000316 return true;
317 }
318
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000404 };
405}
406
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000416 return 3;
417 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000422
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000427}
428
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000435 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000436 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000486
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000516
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518}
519
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000522//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000529//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000534
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000557 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000561 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000564}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000579//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000583
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000592 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000593}
594
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000602 return 0;
603}
604
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000625 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000626}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000627
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000674}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000697
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000698
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000737
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000769
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001054
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001246 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
1365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
1389
1390 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
1406
1407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001413 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001414 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1415 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1416 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1417 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1418 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1419 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001420 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001421 }
1422
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001423 // Limit search depth.
1424 if (Depth == 10)
1425 return false;
1426
1427 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1428 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1429 // are needed.
1430 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1431 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1432 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1433 // the main instcombine process.
1434 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001435 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1436 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001437
1438 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1439 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001440 }
1441
1442 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1443 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1444
1445 bool MadeChange = false;
1446 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1447 Value *TmpV;
1448 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1449 default: break;
1450
1451 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1452 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1453 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001454 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001455 if (Idx == 0) {
1456 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1457 // which elt is getting updated.
1458 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1459 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1460 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1461 break;
1462 }
1463
1464 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1465 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001466 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1468 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1469
1470 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1471 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1472 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1473 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1474 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1475 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1476
1477 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001478 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1479 break;
1480 }
1481 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1482 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
1483 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1484 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1485 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1486 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1487 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
1488 assert(MaskVal < VWidth * 2 &&
1489 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
1490 if (MaskVal < VWidth)
1491 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1492 else
1493 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - VWidth);
1494 }
1495 }
1496 }
1497
1498 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1499 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1500 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1501
1502 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1504 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1505 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1506
1507 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1508 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1509 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001510 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001511 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1512 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1513 } else if (MaskVal < VWidth) {
1514 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1515 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1516 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1517 } else {
1518 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - VWidth)) & 1) << i;
1519 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1520 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1521 }
1522 }
1523
1524 if (NewUndefElts) {
1525 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1526 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1527 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1528 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1529 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1530 else
1531 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1532 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1533 }
1534 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1535 MadeChange = true;
1536 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001537 break;
1538 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001539 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001540 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001541 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1542 if (!VTy) break;
1543 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1544 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1545 unsigned Ratio;
1546
1547 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001548 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001549 // elements as are demanded of us.
1550 Ratio = 1;
1551 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1552 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1553 // Untested so far.
1554 break;
1555
1556 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1557 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1558 // elements are live.
1559 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1561 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1562 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1563 }
1564 } else {
1565 // Untested so far.
1566 break;
1567
1568 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1569 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1570 // live.
1571 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1572 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1573 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1574 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001577 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1578 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1579 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1580 if (TmpV) {
1581 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1582 MadeChange = true;
1583 }
1584
1585 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1586 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1587 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1588 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1589 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1590 // undef.
1591 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1592 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1593 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1594 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1595 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1596 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1597 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1598 // elements are undef.
1599 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1600 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1601 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1602 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1603 }
1604 break;
1605 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001606 case Instruction::And:
1607 case Instruction::Or:
1608 case Instruction::Xor:
1609 case Instruction::Add:
1610 case Instruction::Sub:
1611 case Instruction::Mul:
1612 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1617 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1618 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1619
1620 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1621 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1622 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1623 break;
1624
1625 case Instruction::Call: {
1626 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1627 if (!II) break;
1628 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1629 default: break;
1630
1631 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1632 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1633 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1634 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1639 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1641 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1642 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1643 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1644 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1645 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1646 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1647
1648 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1649 // scalarize it now.
1650 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1651 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1652 default: break;
1653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1654 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1655 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1656 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1657 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1658 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1659 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1660 // Extract the element as scalars.
1661 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1662 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1663
1664 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1665 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1666 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1667 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001668 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001669 II->getName()), *II);
1670 break;
1671 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1672 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001673 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001674 II->getName()), *II);
1675 break;
1676 }
1677
1678 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001679 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1680 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001681 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1682 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1683 return New;
1684 }
1685 }
1686
1687 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1688 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1689 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1690 break;
1691 }
1692 break;
1693 }
1694 }
1695 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1696}
1697
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001698
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001699/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1700/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1701/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1702/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1703/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1704/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1705/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1706///
1707template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001708static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001709 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1710 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1711
1712 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1713 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1714 return F.apply(Root);
1715
1716 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1717 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001718 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001719 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1720 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1721
1722 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1723 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1724 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1725 ShouldApply = true;
1726 }
1727
1728 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1729 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1730 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1732 // and perform the reassociation.
1733 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1734
1735 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1736 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1737
1738 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1739 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001740 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001741 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1742 return 0;
1743 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001744 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001745 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001746 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001747 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001748 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001749
1750 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1751 // get to LHSI.
1752 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1753 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1755 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001756 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001757 ARI = NextLHSI;
1758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1760 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1761 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1762 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1763 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001764
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001765 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1766 // the transformation...
1767 return F.apply(Root);
1768 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001769
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001770 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1771 }
1772 return 0;
1773}
1774
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001775namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001777// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778struct AddRHS {
1779 Value *RHS;
1780 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1782 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001783 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1784 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786};
1787
1788// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1789// iff C1&C2 == 0
1790struct AddMaskingAnd {
1791 Constant *C2;
1792 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1793 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001794 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001795 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001796 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797 }
1798 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001799 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001800 }
1801};
1802
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001803}
1804
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001805static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001806 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001807 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001809 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001810
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001811 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001812 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001813 }
1814
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001815 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001816 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1817 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001818
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001819 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1820 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001821 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1822 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001823 }
1824
1825 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1826 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1827 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1828 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001829 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001830 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001831 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001832 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001833 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001834 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001835 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001836 abort();
1837 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001838 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1839}
1840
1841// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1842// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1843// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1844// not have a second operand.
1845static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1846 InstCombiner *IC) {
1847 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1848 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1849 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1850 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1851
1852 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001853 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001854 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001855
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001856 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1857 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1858
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001859 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1860 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001861 }
1862 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001863}
1864
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001865
1866/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1867/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1868/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1869Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1870 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001871 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001872 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001873
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001874 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1875 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001876 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001877 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1879 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1880 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001881 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001882 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1883
1884 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1885 // loop.
1886 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1887 return 0;
1888 }
1889
1890 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1891 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1892 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1893 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1894 if (NonConstBB) {
1895 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1896 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1897 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001898
1899 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001900 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001901 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001902 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001903 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001904
1905 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1906 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1907 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001908 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001909 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001910 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001911 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1912 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1913 else
1914 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001915 } else {
1916 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1917 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001918 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1920 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001921 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001922 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001923 CI->getPredicate(),
1924 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1925 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 else
1927 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1928
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001929 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001930 }
1931 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001932 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001933 } else {
1934 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1935 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001936 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001937 Value *InV;
1938 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001939 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001940 } else {
1941 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001942 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001943 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1944 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001945 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 }
1947 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001948 }
1949 }
1950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1951}
1952
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001953
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001954/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1955/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1956/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1957/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1958bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1959 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1960 // ones.
1961
1962 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1963 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1964 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1965 // sign extend fine.
1966 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1967 return true;
1968
1969
1970 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1971 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1972 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1973 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1974
1975 // TODO: Implement.
1976
1977 return false;
1978}
1979
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001980
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001982 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001983 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001984
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001985 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001986 // X + undef -> undef
1987 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1989
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001990 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001991 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001992 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001994 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001995 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1996 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001998 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001999
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002000 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002001 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002002 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002003 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002004 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002005 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002006
2007 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2008 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002009 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2010 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2011 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2012 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2013 return &I;
2014 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002015 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002016
2017 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2018 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2019 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002021 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2022 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002023 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2024 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002025 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002026 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002027
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002028 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002029 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2030 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002031 do {
2032 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002033 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2034 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002035 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2036 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002037 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002038 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2039 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002040 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002041 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002042 }
2043 }
2044 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002045 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2046 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2047 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002048
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002049 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002050 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2051 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2052 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002053 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2054 switch (Size) {
2055 default: break;
2056 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2057 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2058 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2059 }
2060 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002061 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002062 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002063 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002064 }
2065 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002066 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002067
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002068 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2069 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2070
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002071 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002072 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002073 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002074
2075 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2076 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2077 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2079 }
2080 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2081 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2082 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2084 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002085 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002086
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002087 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002088 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2089 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002090 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2091 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002092 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002093 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002094 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002095 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002096 }
2097
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002098 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002099 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002100
2101 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002102 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2103 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002104 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002105
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002106
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002107 ConstantInt *C2;
2108 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2109 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002111
2112 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2113 ConstantInt *C1;
2114 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002115 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002116 }
2117
2118 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002119 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002121
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002122 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002123 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002125
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002126
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002127 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002128 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002129 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2130 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002131
2132 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2133 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2134 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2135 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2136 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2137 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2138 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2139 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2140 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2141 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2142
2143 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002144 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002145 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002146 }
2147 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002148
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002149 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002150 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002151 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2152 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2153 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2154 if (W != Y) {
2155 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002156 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002157 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002158 std::swap(W, X);
2159 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002160 std::swap(Y, Z);
2161 std::swap(W, X);
2162 }
2163 }
2164
2165 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002166 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002168 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002169 }
2170 }
2171 }
2172
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002173 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002174 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002175 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002176 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002177
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002178 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2179 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002180 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002181 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2182 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2183 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002184 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002185
2186 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002187 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002188
2189 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002190 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002191
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002192 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2193 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002194 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002195 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002196 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002197 }
2198 }
2199 }
2200
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002201 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2202 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002203 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002204 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002205 }
2206
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002207 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002208 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002209 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002210 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2211 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002212 if (!CI) {
2213 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2214 Other = LHS;
2215 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002216 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002217 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2218 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002219 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002220 unsigned AS =
2221 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002222 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2223 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002224 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002225 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002226 }
2227 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002228
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002229 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002230 {
2231 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2232 Value *Other = RHS;
2233 if (!SI) {
2234 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2235 Other = LHS;
2236 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002237 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002238 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2239 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002240 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002241
2242 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2243 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002244 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2245 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002246 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002247 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2248 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002249 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002250 }
2251 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002252
2253 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2254 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2255 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002257
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002258 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2259 // integer add followed by a sext.
2260 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2261 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2262 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2263 Constant *CI =
2264 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2265 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2266 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2267 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2268 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2269 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2270 CI, "addconv");
2271 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2272 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2273 }
2274 }
2275
2276 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2277 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2278 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2279 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2280 // integer add will not overflow.
2281 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2282 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2283 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2284 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2285 // Insert the new integer add.
2286 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2287 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2288 "addconv");
2289 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2290 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2291 }
2292 }
2293 }
2294
2295 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2296 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2297 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2298 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2299 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2300 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2301 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2302 // instcombined.
2303 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2304 Constant *CI =
2305 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2306 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2307 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2308 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2309 // Insert the new integer add.
2310 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2311 CI, "addconv");
2312 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2313 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2314 }
2315 }
2316
2317 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2318 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2319 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2320 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2321 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2322 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2323 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2324 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2325 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2326 // Insert the new integer add.
2327 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2328 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2329 "addconv");
2330 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2331 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2332 }
2333 }
2334 }
2335
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002336 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002337}
2338
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002339Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002340 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002341
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002342 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2343 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002345
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002346 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002347 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002348 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002349
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002350 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2352 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2354
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002355 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2356 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002357 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002358 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002359
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002360 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002361 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002362 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002363 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002364
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002365 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2366 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002367 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002368 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002369 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002370 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002371 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002372 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002373 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002374 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002376 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002377 }
2378 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002379 }
2380 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2381 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2382 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002383 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002384 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002385 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002386 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002387 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002388 }
2389 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002390 }
2391 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002392 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002393
2394 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2395 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002396 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002397 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002398
2399 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2400 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2401 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002402 }
2403
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002404 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2405 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2406
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002407 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2408 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002409 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002410 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002411 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002412 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002413 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002414 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2415 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2416 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002417 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002418 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2419 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002420 }
2421
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002422 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002423 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2424 // is not used by anyone else...
2425 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002426 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002427 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002428 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2429 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2430 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2431 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002432
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002433 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002434 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002435 }
2436
2437 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2438 //
2439 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2440 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2441 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2442
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002443 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002444 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2445 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002447
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002448 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002449 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002450 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002451 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002452 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002453 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002454 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2455
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002456 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002457 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002458 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002459 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002460 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002461 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002462
2463 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2464 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2465 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2466 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2467 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2468 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002470 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002472 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002473 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002474 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002475
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002476 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002477 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002478 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002479 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2481 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002483 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2484 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002486 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002487 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002488
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002489 ConstantInt *C1;
2490 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002491 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002492 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002493
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002494 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2495 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002496 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002497 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002498 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002499}
2500
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002501/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2502/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2503/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2504/// signed.
2505static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2506 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002507 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2509 TrueIfSigned = true;
2510 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2512 TrueIfSigned = true;
2513 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2515 TrueIfSigned = false;
2516 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2518 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2519 TrueIfSigned = true;
2520 return RHS->getValue() ==
2521 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2523 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2524 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002525 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002526 default:
2527 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002528 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002529}
2530
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002531Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002532 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002533 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002534
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002535 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2537
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002538 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002539 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2540 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002541
2542 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002543 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002544 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2545 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002546 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002547 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002548
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002549 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2551 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2553 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002555
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002556 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002557 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002558 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002559 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002560 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002561 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002562 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002564
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002565 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2566 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002567 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2569 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2570 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2572
2573 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2574 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2575 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2576 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002578 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002579
2580 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2581 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002582 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002583 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002584 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002585 Op1, "tmp");
2586 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2587 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2588 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002589 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002590
2591 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002592
2593 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2594 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002595 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002596 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002597
2598 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2599 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2600 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002601 }
2602
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002603 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2604 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002606
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002607 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2608 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2609
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002610 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2611 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2612 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2613 // formed.
2614 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002615 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002616 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002617 BoolCast = CI;
2618 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002619 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002620 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002621 BoolCast = CI;
2622 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002623 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002624 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2625 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002626 bool TIS = false;
2627
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002628 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002629 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2630 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002631 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2632 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002633 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002634 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002635 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002636 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002637 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002638 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002639 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2640 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002641
2642 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2643 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002644 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002645 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2646 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002647 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2648 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2649 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2650 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2651 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002652
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002653 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002654 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002655 }
2656 }
2657 }
2658
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002659 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002660}
2661
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002662/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2663/// instruction.
2664bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2665 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2666
2667 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2668 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2669 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2670 if (ST->isNullValue())
2671 NonNullOperand = 2;
2672 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2673 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2674 if (ST->isNullValue())
2675 NonNullOperand = 1;
2676
2677 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2678 return false;
2679
2680 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2681
2682 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2683 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2684
2685 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2686 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2687 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2688 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2689 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2690
2691 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2692 // early exit.
2693 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2694 return true;
2695
2696 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2697 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2698
2699 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2700 --BBI;
2701 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2702 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2703 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2704 break;
2705
2706 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2707 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2708 I != E; ++I) {
2709 if (*I == SI) {
2710 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2711 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2712 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2713 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2714 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2715 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2716 }
2717 }
2718
2719 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2720 if (&*BBI == SI)
2721 SI = 0;
2722 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2723 SelectCond = 0;
2724
2725 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2726 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2727 break;
2728
2729 }
2730 return true;
2731}
2732
2733
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002734/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2735/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2736/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2737/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002738Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002739 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002740
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002741 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2742 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2743 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2744 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002747 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748
2749 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002750 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002752
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002753 return 0;
2754}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002755
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002756/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2757/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2758/// division instructions.
2759/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002760Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002761 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2762
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002763 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002764 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2765 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2766 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2767 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2769 }
2770
2771 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2773 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002774
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002775 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2776 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002777
2778 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2779 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2780 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2781 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002782
2783 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2784 // div X, 1 == X
2785 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2787
2788 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2789 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2790 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2791 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002792 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2794 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002795 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002796 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002797 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002798
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002799 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002800 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2801 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2802 return R;
2803 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2804 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2805 return NV;
2806 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002807 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002808
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002809 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002810 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002811 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2813
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002814 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2815 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2817
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002818 return 0;
2819}
2820
2821Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2822 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2823
2824 // Handle the integer div common cases
2825 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2826 return Common;
2827
2828 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2829 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2830 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2831 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002832 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002833 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002834 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002835 }
2836
2837 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002838 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002839 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2840 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002841 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002842 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002843 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002844 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002845 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002846 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002847 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002848 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002849 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002850 }
2851 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002852 }
2853
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002854 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2855 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002856 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002857 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002858 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002859 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002860 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002861 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002862 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002863 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2864 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002866 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2867 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2868
2869 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2870 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002871 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002872 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2873 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002875 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002876 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002877 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002878 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002879 return 0;
2880}
2881
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2883 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2884
2885 // Handle the integer div common cases
2886 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2887 return Common;
2888
2889 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2890 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2891 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002892 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002893
2894 // -X/C -> X/-C
2895 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002896 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002897 }
2898
2899 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2900 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002901 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002902 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002903 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002904 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002905 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002906 }
2907 }
2908
2909 return 0;
2910}
2911
2912Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2913 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2914}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002915
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002916/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2917/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2918/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2919/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2920Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002921 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002922
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002923 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002924 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2925 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2927
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002928 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2929 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002932 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002933 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002935
2936 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002937 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2938 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002939
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002940 return 0;
2941}
2942
2943/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2944/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2945/// remainder instructions.
2946/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2947Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2948 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2949
2950 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2951 return common;
2952
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002953 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002954 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2955 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2957
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002958 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2960
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002961 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2962 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2963 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2964 return R;
2965 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2966 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2967 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002968 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002969
2970 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2971 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2972 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2973 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2974 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2975 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002976 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002977 }
2978
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002979 return 0;
2980}
2981
2982Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2983 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2984
2985 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2986 return common;
2987
2988 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2989 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2990 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2991 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2992 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002993 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002994 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002995 }
2996
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002997 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002998 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2999 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3000 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003001 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003002 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003003 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003004 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003005 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003006 }
3007 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003008 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003009
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003010 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3011 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3012 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3013 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3014 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3015 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003016 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3017 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003018 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003020 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003022 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003023 }
3024 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003025 }
3026
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003027 return 0;
3028}
3029
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003030Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3031 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3032
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003033 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3035 return common;
3036
3037 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003038 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3039 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3040 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003041 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3042 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3043 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3044 return &I;
3045 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003046
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003047 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003048 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003049 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3050 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3051 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3052 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003053 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003054 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003055 }
3056
3057 return 0;
3058}
3059
3060Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003061 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3062}
3063
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003064// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3065// constant.
3066static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003067 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003068}
3069
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003070// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3071// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3072static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003073 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003074}
3075
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003076/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003077/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3078///
3079/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3080///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003081/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3082/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003083///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003084/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3085/// 0 A > B
3086/// 1 A == B
3087/// 2 A < B
3088///
3089/// <=> Value Definition
3090/// 000 0 Always false
3091/// 001 1 A > B
3092/// 010 2 A == B
3093/// 011 3 A >= B
3094/// 100 4 A < B
3095/// 101 5 A != B
3096/// 110 6 A <= B
3097/// 111 7 Always true
3098///
3099static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3100 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003101 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003102 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3103 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3104 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3105 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3106 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3107 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3108 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3109 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3110 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3111 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003112 // True -> 7
3113 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003114 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003115 return 0;
3116 }
3117}
3118
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003119/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3120/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3121/// predicate by reference.
3122static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3123 isOrdered = false;
3124 switch (CC) {
3125 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3126 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003127 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3128 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3129 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3130 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003131 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3132 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3133 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3134 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003135 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3136 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003137 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3138 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003139 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003140 default:
3141 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3142 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3143 return 0;
3144 }
3145}
3146
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003147/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3148/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003149/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003150/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003151static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3152 switch (code) {
3153 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003154 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003155 case 1:
3156 if (sign)
3157 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3158 else
3159 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3160 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3161 case 3:
3162 if (sign)
3163 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3164 else
3165 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3166 case 4:
3167 if (sign)
3168 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3169 else
3170 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3171 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3172 case 6:
3173 if (sign)
3174 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3175 else
3176 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003177 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003178 }
3179}
3180
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003181/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3182/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3183/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3184static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3185 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3186 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003187 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003188 case 0:
3189 if (isordered)
3190 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3191 else
3192 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3193 case 1:
3194 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003195 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3196 else
3197 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003198 case 2:
3199 if (isordered)
3200 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3201 else
3202 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003203 case 3:
3204 if (isordered)
3205 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3206 else
3207 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3208 case 4:
3209 if (isordered)
3210 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3211 else
3212 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3213 case 5:
3214 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003215 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3216 else
3217 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3218 case 6:
3219 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003220 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3221 else
3222 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003223 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003224 }
3225}
3226
3227
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003228static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3229 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3230 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3231 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3232 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3233 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3234}
3235
3236namespace {
3237// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3238struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003239 InstCombiner &IC;
3240 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003241 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3242 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3243 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3244 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003245 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003246 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3247 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003248 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3249 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003250 return false;
3251 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003252 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3253 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3254 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3255 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3256 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003257 }
3258
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003259 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003260 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003261 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003262 unsigned Code;
3263 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3264 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3265 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3266 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003267 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003268 }
3269
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003270 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3271 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3272
3273 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003274 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3275 return I;
3276 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3277 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3278 }
3279};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003280} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003281
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003282// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3283// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003284// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003285Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003286 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3287 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003288 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3289 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003290 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003291 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003292 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003293
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003294 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3295 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003296 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003297 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003298 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003299 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003300 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003301 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003302 }
3303 break;
3304 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003305 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003307
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003308 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3309 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003310 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003311 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003312 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003313 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003314 }
3315 break;
3316 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003317 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003318 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3319 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3320 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003321 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003322
3323 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003324 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003325 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3326 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3327 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003328 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003329
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003330 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3331 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3332 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3333 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3334 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3335 // no effect.
3336 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3337 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3338 return &TheAnd;
3339 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003340 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003341 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003342 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003343 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003344 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003345 }
3346 }
3347 }
3348 }
3349 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003350
3351 case Instruction::Shl: {
3352 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3353 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3354 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003355 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003356 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003357 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3358 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003359
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003360 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3361 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3363 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003364 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3365 return &TheAnd;
3366 }
3367 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003368 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003369 case Instruction::LShr:
3370 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003371 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3372 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3373 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3374 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003375 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003376 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003377 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3378 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003379
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003380 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3381 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3383 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3384 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3385 return &TheAnd;
3386 }
3387 break;
3388 }
3389 case Instruction::AShr:
3390 // Signed shr.
3391 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3392 // with an and.
3393 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003394 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003395 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003396 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3397 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003398 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003399 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003400 // Make the argument unsigned.
3401 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003402 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003403 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003404 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003405 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003406 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003407 }
3408 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003409 }
3410 return 0;
3411}
3412
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003413
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003414/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3415/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003416/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3417/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003418/// insert new instructions.
3419Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003420 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3421 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003422 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003423 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003424 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003425
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003426 if (Inside) {
3427 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003428 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003429
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003430 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003431 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003432 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003433 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3434 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3435 }
3436
3437 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3438 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003439 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003440 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003441 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3442 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003443 }
3444
3445 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003446 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003447
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003448 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003449 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003450 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003451 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3452 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3453 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3454 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003455
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003456 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3457 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3458 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003459 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003460 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003461 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3462 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003463}
3464
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003465// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3466// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3467// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3468// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003469static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003470 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003471 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3472 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003473
3474 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003475 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003476 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003477 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003478 return true;
3479}
3480
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003481/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3482/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3483/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003484///
3485/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3486/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3487/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3488///
3489/// return (A +/- B).
3490///
3491Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003492 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003493 Instruction &I) {
3494 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3495 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3496 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3497
3498 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3499
3500 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3501 default: return 0;
3502 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003503 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003504 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003505 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3506 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3507 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003508 break;
3509
3510 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3511 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3512 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003513 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003514 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003515 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003516 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003517 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003518 break;
3519 }
3520 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003521 return 0;
3522 case Instruction::Or:
3523 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003524 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003525 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3526 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003527 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003528 break;
3529 return 0;
3530 }
3531
3532 Instruction *New;
3533 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003534 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003535 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003536 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003537 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3538}
3539
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003540Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003541 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003542 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003543
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003544 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3546
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003547 // and X, X = X
3548 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003550
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003551 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003552 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003553 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003554 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3555 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3556 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003557 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003558 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003559 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003560 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003561 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003563 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003565 }
3566 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003567
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003568 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003569 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3570 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003571
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003572 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003573 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003574 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003575 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3576 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3577 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3578 case Instruction::Xor:
3579 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003580 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3581 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3582 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3583 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003584 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003585 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3586 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003587 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003588 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003589 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003590 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003591 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3592 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003593 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003594 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3595 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003596 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003597 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3598 }
3599 }
3600
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003601 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003602 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003603 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3604 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3605 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3606 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003607 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003608 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003609 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003610 break;
3611
3612 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003613 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3614 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3615 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3616 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003617 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003618
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003619 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3620 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3621 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3622 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3623 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3624 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3625
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003626 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003627 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3628 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003629 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3630 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3632 }
3633 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003634 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003635
3636 case Instruction::Shl:
3637 case Instruction::LShr:
3638 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3639 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003640 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003641 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3642 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3643 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3644 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3645 }
3646 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003647 }
3648
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003649 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003650 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003651 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003652 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003653 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3654 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3655 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3656 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003657 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003658 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003659 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003660 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3661 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003662 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3663 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3664 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003665 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003666 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3667 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003668 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003669 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003670 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003671 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003672 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003673 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3674 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3675 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003676 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003677 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3679 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003680 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003681 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003682 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003683
3684 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3685 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003686 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003687 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003688 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3689 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3690 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003691 }
3692
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003693 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3694 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003695
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003696 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3698
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003699 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003700 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003701 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003702 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003703 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003704 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003705 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003706
3707 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003708 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3709 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003710 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003712
3713 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3714 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3715 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003716 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003717 }
3718 }
3719
3720 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003721 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3722 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003723
3724 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3725 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3726 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003727 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003728 }
3729 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003730
3731 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3732 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3733 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3734 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3735 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3736 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3737 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3738 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3739 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3740 }
3741 }
3742 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3743 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3744 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3745 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3746 std::swap(A, B);
3747 }
3748 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003749 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003750 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003751 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003752 }
3753 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003754 }
3755
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003756 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3757 // where C is a power of 2
3758 Value *A, *B;
3759 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003760 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3761 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003762 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3763 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3764 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3765 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3766 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3767 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3768 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3769 }
3770 }
3771
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003772 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3773 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3774 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003775 return R;
3776
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003777 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3778 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003779 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3780 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3781 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3782 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3783 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3784 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3785 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3786 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003787 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3788
3789 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3790 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3791 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3792 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003793 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003794 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3795 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3796 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3797 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3798 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3799 else
3800 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3801
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003802 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3803 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003804 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003805 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3806 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3807 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3808 }
3809
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003810 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003811 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3812 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3814 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3815 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003816 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3817
3818 switch (LHSCC) {
3819 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003821 switch (RHSCC) {
3822 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003823 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3824 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3825 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003827 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3828 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3831 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003832 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003833 switch (RHSCC) {
3834 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003835 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3836 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3837 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3838 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3840 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3841 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3842 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3844 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3848 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003849 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003850 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003851 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3852 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3854 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003855 }
3856 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3857 }
3858 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003860 switch (RHSCC) {
3861 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3866 break;
3867 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3871 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003872 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003873 break;
3874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003875 switch (RHSCC) {
3876 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3881 break;
3882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3886 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003887 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003888 break;
3889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3890 switch (RHSCC) {
3891 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003892 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3896 break;
3897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3898 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3899 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3900 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3902 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3903 true, I);
3904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3905 break;
3906 }
3907 break;
3908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3909 switch (RHSCC) {
3910 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3914 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3915 break;
3916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3917 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3918 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3919 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3921 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3922 true, I);
3923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3924 break;
3925 }
3926 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003927 }
3928 }
3929 }
3930
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003931 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003932 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3933 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3934 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3935 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003936 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003937 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003938 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3939 I.getType(), TD) &&
3940 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3941 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003942 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003943 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3944 I.getName());
3945 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003946 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003947 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003948 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003949
3950 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003951 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3952 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3953 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003954 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3955 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3956 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003957 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003958 SI1->getOperand(0),
3959 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003960 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003961 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003962 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003963 }
3964
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003965 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003966 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3967 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3968 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003969 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3970 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003971 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3972 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3973 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3974 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003975 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3977 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3978 RHS->getOperand(0));
3979 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003980 } else {
3981 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
3982 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
3983 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
3984 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003985 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3986 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3987 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
3988 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
3989 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003990 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
3991 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
3992 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
3993 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
3994 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
3995 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
3996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3997 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3999 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4001 bool Op0Ordered;
4002 bool Op1Ordered;
4003 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4004 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4005 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4006 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4007 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4008 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4009 }
4010 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4011 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4012 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4013 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4015 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4016 // uno && ord -> false
4017 if (!Op0Ordered)
4018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4019 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4020 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4021 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4022 }
4023 }
4024 }
4025 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004026 }
4027 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004028
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004029 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004030}
4031
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004032/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4033/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4034/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4035/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4036/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4037/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4038/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4039/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4040/// match.
4041///
4042/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4043/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4044/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4045/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4046/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4047/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4048///
4049/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4050/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4051/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4052/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4053/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4054///
4055static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4056 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4057 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4058 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4059 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4060 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4061 ByteValues) ||
4062 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4063 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004064 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004065
4066 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4067 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4068 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4069 unsigned ShAmt =
4070 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4071 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4072 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4073 return true;
4074
4075 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4076 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4077 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4078 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4079 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4080 } else {
4081 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4082 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4083 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004084 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004085 }
4086
4087 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4088 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4089
4090 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4091 ByteValues);
4092 }
4093
4094 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4095 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4096 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4097 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4098 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4099 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4100 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4101 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4102
4103 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4104 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4105 // the and mask is.
4106 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4107 continue;
4108
4109 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4110 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4111 if (MaskB == 0) {
4112 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4113 continue;
4114 }
4115
4116 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4117 if (MaskB != Byte)
4118 return true;
4119
4120 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4121 }
4122
4123 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4124 ByteValues);
4125 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004126 }
4127
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004128 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4129 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4130 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4131 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4132 // their ultimate destination.
4133 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4134 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004135
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004136 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4137 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4138 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4139 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4140 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4141 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4142 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4143 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4144 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4145 return true;
4146 } else {
4147 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4148 return true;
4149 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004150
4151 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4152 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004153 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004154 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004155 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004156 return false;
4157}
4158
4159/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4160/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4161Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004162 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004163 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4164 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4165 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004166 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004167
4168 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4169 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004170 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004171 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004172
4173 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004174 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4175 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004176 return 0;
4177
4178 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4179 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4180 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4181
4182 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4183 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4184 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4185 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004186 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004187 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004188 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004189 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004190}
4191
4192
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004193Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004194 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004195 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004196
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004197 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004199
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004200 // or X, X = X
4201 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004203
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004204 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4205 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004206 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4207 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4208 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4209 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4210 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4211 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004212 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4214 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4215 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004217 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004218
4219
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004220
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004221 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004222 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004223 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004224 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4225 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004226 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004227 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004228 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004229 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004230 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004231 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004232
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004233 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4234 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004235 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004236 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004237 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004238 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004239 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004240 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004241
4242 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4243 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004244 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004245 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004246 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4247 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4248 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004249 }
4250
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004251 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4252 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004253
4254 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4255 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4257 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4258 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4260
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004261 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4262 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004263 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004264 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4265 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4266 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004267 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4268 return BSwap;
4269 }
4270
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004271 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4272 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004273 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004274 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004275 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4276 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004277 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004278 }
4279
4280 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4281 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004282 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004283 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004284 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4285 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004286 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004287 }
4288
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004289 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004290 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004291 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4292 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004293 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4294 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4295 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4296 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4297 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4298 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4299 // replace with V+N.
4300 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4301 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4302 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4303 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4304 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4306 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4308 }
4309 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4310 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4311 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4312 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4313 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4315 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4317 }
4318 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004319 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004320 }
4321
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004322 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4323 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004324 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4325 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4326 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4327 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4328 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4329 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4330 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4331 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4332 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4333
4334 if (V1) {
4335 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004336 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4337 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004338 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004339 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004340 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004341
4342 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004343 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4344 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4345 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004346 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4347 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4348 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004349 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004350 SI1->getOperand(0),
4351 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004352 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004353 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004354 }
4355 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004356
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004357 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4358 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004360 } else {
4361 A = 0;
4362 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004363 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004364 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4365 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004366 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004367
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004368 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004369 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004370 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004371 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004372 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004373 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004374 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004375
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004376 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4377 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4378 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004379 return R;
4380
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004381 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4382 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004383 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4384 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4385 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4386 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4387 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4388 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4389 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4390 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004391 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4392 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4393 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004394 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004395 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004396 bool NeedsSwap;
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00004397 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4398 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004399 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004400 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004401 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004402
4403 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004404 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4405 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4406 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4407 }
4408
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004409 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004410 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4411 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004412 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4413 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004414 // equal.
4415 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4416
4417 switch (LHSCC) {
4418 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004419 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004420 switch (RHSCC) {
4421 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004423 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4424 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004425 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004426 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4427 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004428 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004429 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004430 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004431 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4432 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4433 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004434 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004435 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4439 }
4440 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004442 switch (RHSCC) {
4443 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004444 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4445 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4446 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004448 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4449 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4450 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004452 }
4453 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004454 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004455 switch (RHSCC) {
4456 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004457 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004458 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004459 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004460 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4461 // this can cause overflow.
4462 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004464 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4465 false, I);
4466 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4467 break;
4468 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4469 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004471 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4472 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004473 }
4474 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004476 switch (RHSCC) {
4477 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4479 break;
4480 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004481 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4482 // this can cause overflow.
4483 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004485 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4486 false, I);
4487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4488 break;
4489 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4493 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004494 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004495 break;
4496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4497 switch (RHSCC) {
4498 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4499 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4500 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4502 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4503 break;
4504 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4505 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004506 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4508 break;
4509 }
4510 break;
4511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4512 switch (RHSCC) {
4513 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4515 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4518 break;
4519 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004521 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4523 break;
4524 }
4525 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004526 }
4527 }
4528 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004529
4530 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004531 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004532 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004533 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004534 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4535 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4536 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4537 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4538 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4539 // generated.
4540 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4541 I.getType(), TD) &&
4542 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4543 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004544 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004545 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4546 I.getName());
4547 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004548 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004549 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004550 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004551 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004552 }
4553
4554
4555 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4556 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4557 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4558 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004559 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004560 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004561 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4562 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4563 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4564 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004565 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4567
4568 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4569 // rest.
4570 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4571 RHS->getOperand(0));
4572 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004573 } else {
4574 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4575 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4576 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4577 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4578 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4579 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4580 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4581 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4582 }
4583 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4584 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4585 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4586 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4587 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4588 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4590 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4591 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4592 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4594 bool Op0Ordered;
4595 bool Op1Ordered;
4596 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4597 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4598 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4599 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4600 // or'ed predicates.
4601 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4602 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4603 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4604 return I;
4605 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4606 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4607 }
4608 }
4609 }
4610 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004611 }
4612 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004613
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004614 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004615}
4616
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004617namespace {
4618
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004619// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4620struct XorSelf {
4621 Value *RHS;
4622 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4623 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4624 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4625 return &Xor;
4626 }
4627};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004628
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004629}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004630
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004631Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004632 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004633 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004634
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004635 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4636 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4637 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4638 // idiom (misuse).
4639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004641 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004642
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004643 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4644 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004645 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004646 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004647 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004648
4649 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4650 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004651 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4652 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4653 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4654 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4655 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4656 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004657 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004659 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004660
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004661 // Is this a ~ operation?
4662 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4663 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4664 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4665 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4666 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4667 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4668 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4669 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4670 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004671 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004672 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4673 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4674 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004675 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004676 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004677 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004678 }
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
4682
4683
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004684 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004685 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4686 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4687 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004688 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4689 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004690
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004691 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4692 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4693 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4694 }
4695
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004696 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4697 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4698 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4699 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4700 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4701 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4702 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4703 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4704 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4705 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4706 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4707 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4708 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4709 }
4710 }
4711 }
4712 }
4713 }
4714
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004715 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004716 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004717 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4718 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004719 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4720 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004721 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004722 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004723 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004724
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004725 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004726 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004727 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004728 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004729 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004730 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004731 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004732 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004733 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004734 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004735 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4736 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004737 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004738
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004739 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004740 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4741 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004742 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004743 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4744 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4745 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004746 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004747 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4748 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004749 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004750 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4751 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4752 return &I;
4753 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004754 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004755 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004756 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004757
4758 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4759 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004760 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004761 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004762 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4763 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4764 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004765 }
4766
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004767 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004768 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004770
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004771 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004772 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004774
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004775
4776 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4777 if (Op1I) {
4778 Value *A, *B;
4779 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4780 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004781 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004782 I.swapOperands();
4783 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004784 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004785 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004786 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004787 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004788 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4789 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4791 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4793 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004794 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004795 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004796 std::swap(A, B);
4797 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004798 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004799 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4800 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4801 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004802 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004803 }
4804
4805 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4806 if (Op0I) {
4807 Value *A, *B;
4808 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4809 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4810 std::swap(A, B);
4811 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4812 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004813 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4814 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004815 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004816 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4817 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4818 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4819 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4820 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4821 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4822 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4823 std::swap(A, B);
4824 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004825 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004826 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004827 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4828 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004829 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004830 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004831 }
4832
4833 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4834 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4835 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4836 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4837 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4838 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004839 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004840 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4841 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004842 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004843 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4844 }
4845
4846 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4847 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4848 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4849 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4850 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4851 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004852 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004853 }
4854 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4855 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4856 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4857 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004858 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004859 }
4860
4861 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4862 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4863 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4864 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4865 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4866 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4867 if (A == C)
4868 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4869 else if (A == D)
4870 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4871 else if (B == C)
4872 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4873 else if (B == D)
4874 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4875
4876 if (X) {
4877 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004878 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4879 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004880 }
4881 }
4882 }
4883
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004884 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4885 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4886 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004887 return R;
4888
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004889 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004890 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004891 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004892 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4893 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004894 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004895 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004896 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4897 I.getType(), TD) &&
4898 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4899 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004900 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004901 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4902 I.getName());
4903 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004904 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004905 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004906 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004907 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004908
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004909 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004910}
4911
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004912/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4913/// overflowed for this type.
4914static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004915 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004916 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004917
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004918 if (IsSigned)
4919 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4920 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4921 else
4922 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4923 else
4924 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004925}
4926
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004927/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4928/// overflowed for this type.
4929static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4930 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004931 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004932
4933 if (IsSigned)
4934 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4935 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4936 else
4937 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4938 else
4939 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
4940}
4941
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004942/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4943/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4944/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4945static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4946 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4947 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004948 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4949 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004950
4951 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004952 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004953 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004954
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004955 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4956 ++i, ++GTI) {
4957 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004958 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004959 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4960 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4961
4962 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4963 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4964 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4965
4966 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4967 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004968 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004969 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004970 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004971 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4972 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4973 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004974 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004975
4976 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4977 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4978 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4979 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4980 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4981 else {
4982 // Emit an add instruction.
4983 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004984 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004985 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004986 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004987 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004988 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004989 // Convert to correct type.
4990 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4991 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4992 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4993 else
4994 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4995 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4996 }
4997 if (Size != 1) {
4998 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4999 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5000 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5001 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005002 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005003 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5004 }
5005
5006 // Emit an add instruction.
5007 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5008 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5009 cast<Constant>(Result));
5010 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005011 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005012 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005013 }
5014 return Result;
5015}
5016
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005017
5018/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5019/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5020/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5021/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5022/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5023/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5024/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5025///
5026/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5027///
5028static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5029 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005030 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5031 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5032
5033 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5034 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5035 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5036 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5037 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5038 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5039 int64_t Offset = 0;
5040 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5041 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5042 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5043 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5044
5045 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5046 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5047 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5048 } else {
5049 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5050 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5051 }
5052 } else {
5053 // Found our variable index.
5054 break;
5055 }
5056 }
5057
5058 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5059 // evaluate it the general way.
5060 if (i == e) return 0;
5061
5062 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5063 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5064 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5065 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5066
5067 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5068 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5069 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5070 if (!CI) return 0;
5071
5072 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5073 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5074
5075 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5076 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5077 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5078 } else {
5079 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5080 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5081 }
5082 }
5083
5084 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5085 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5086 // the index.
5087 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5088 if (Offset == 0) {
5089 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5090 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5091 // computation crosses zero.
5092 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5093 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5094 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5095 return VariableIdx;
5096 }
5097
5098 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5099 // the pointer size, so get it.
5100 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5101
5102 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5103 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5104
5105 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5106 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5107 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5108 // multiple of the variable scale.
5109 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5110 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5111 return 0;
5112
5113 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5114 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5115 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005116 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005117 true /*SExt*/,
5118 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5119 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005120 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005121}
5122
5123
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005124/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005125/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005126Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5127 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5128 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005129 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005130
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005131 // Look through bitcasts.
5132 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5133 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005134
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005135 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5136 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005137 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005138 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5139 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5140 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5141
5142 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5143 if (Offset == 0)
5144 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005145 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5146 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005147 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005148 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5149 // compare the base pointer.
5150 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5151 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005152 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005153 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005154 if (IndicesTheSame)
5155 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5156 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5157 IndicesTheSame = false;
5158 break;
5159 }
5160
5161 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5162 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005163 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5164 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005165
5166 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5167 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005168 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005169 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005170
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005171 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5172 bool AllZeros = true;
5173 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5174 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5175 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5176 AllZeros = false;
5177 break;
5178 }
5179 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005180 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5181 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005182
5183 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005184 AllZeros = true;
5185 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5186 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5187 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5188 AllZeros = false;
5189 break;
5190 }
5191 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005192 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005193
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005194 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5195 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5196 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5197 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5198 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5199 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005200 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5201 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005202 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005203 NumDifferences = 2;
5204 break;
5205 } else {
5206 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5207 DiffOperand = i;
5208 }
5209 }
5210
5211 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005213 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005214 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005215
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005216 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005217 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5218 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005219 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5220 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005221 }
5222 }
5223
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005224 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005225 // the result to fold to a constant!
5226 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5227 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5228 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5229 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5230 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005231 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005232 }
5233 }
5234 return 0;
5235}
5236
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005237/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5238///
5239Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5240 Instruction *LHSI,
5241 Constant *RHSC) {
5242 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5243 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5244
5245 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5246 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005247 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005248 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5249
5250 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5251 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5252 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5253 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5254
5255 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
5256 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
5257 ++InputSize;
5258
5259 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5260 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5261 return 0;
5262
5263 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5264 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5265 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5266 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5267
5268 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5269 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5270 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5271 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
5272 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
5273 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
5274 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
5275 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
5276 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
5277 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
5278 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
5279 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
5280 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
5281 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
5282 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
5283 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5285 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5287 }
5288
5289 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5290
5291 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5292
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005293 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005294 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5295 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5296
5297 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5298 // and large values.
5299 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5300 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5301 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5302 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005303 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5304 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5307 }
5308
5309 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5310 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5311 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5312 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5313 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005314 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5315 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5317 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5318 }
5319
5320 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5321 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5322 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5323 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5324 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5325 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5326 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5327 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5328 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5329 // zero at this point.
5330 switch (Pred) {
5331 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5332 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5334 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5335 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5336 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5337 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5338 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5339 if (RHS.isNegative())
5340 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5341 break;
5342 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5343 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5344 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5345 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5346 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5347 break;
5348 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5349 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5350 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5351 if (RHS.isNegative())
5352 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5353 break;
5354 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5355 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5356 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5357 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5358 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5359 break;
5360 }
5361 }
5362
5363 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5364 // comparison.
5365 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5366}
5367
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005368Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5369 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005370 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005371
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005372 // Fold trivial predicates.
5373 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5375 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5377
5378 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5379 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5380 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5381 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5382 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5383 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5384 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5386 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5387 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5388 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5390
5391 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5392 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5393 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5394 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5395 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5396 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5397 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5398 return &I;
5399
5400 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5401 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5402 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5403 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5404 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5405 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5406 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5407 return &I;
5408 }
5409 }
5410
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005411 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005413
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005414 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5415 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005416 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5417 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5418 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5419 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5420 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005421 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5422 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5423 // True if unordered.
5424 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005425 }
5426 }
5427
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005428 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5429 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5430 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005431 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5432 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5433 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5434 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5435 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5436 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005437 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005438 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5439 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5440 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5441 return NV;
5442 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005443 case Instruction::Select:
5444 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5445 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5446 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5447 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5448 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5449 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5450 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5451 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5452 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5453 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5454 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5455 I.getName()), I);
5456 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5457 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5458 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5459 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5460 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5461 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5462 I.getName()), I);
5463 }
5464 }
5465
5466 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005467 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005468 break;
5469 }
5470 }
5471
5472 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5473}
5474
5475Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5476 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5477 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5478 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5479
5480 // icmp X, X
5481 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005483 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005484
5485 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005487
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005488 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005489 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005490 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5491 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5492 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005493 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005495 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005496
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005497 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005498 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005499 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5500 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005501 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005502 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005503 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005504 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005505 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005506 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005507 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005508
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005509 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005510 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005511 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005513 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005514 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005515 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005516 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5518 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005519 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5521 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5522 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5523 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5524 }
5525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5526 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5527 // FALL THROUGH
5528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005529 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005530 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005531 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005532 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5534 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5535 // FALL THROUGH
5536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5537 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5538 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5539 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5540 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005541 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005542 }
5543
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005544 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005545 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005546 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005547
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005548 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5549 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5550 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5551 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5552 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005553 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005554
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005555 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5556 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5557 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005558 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5559 default: break;
5560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5561 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5563 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5565 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5567 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5569 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5571 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5573 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5575 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5576 }
5577
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005578 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5579 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5580 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5581 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5582
5583 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005584 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005585 bool UnusedBit;
5586 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5587
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005588 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5589 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5590 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005591 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5592 return &I;
5593
5594 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005595 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5596 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5597 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005598 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5599 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5600 else
5601 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5602
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005603 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5604 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5605 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5606 if (Min == Max)
5607 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5608 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5609 CI));
5610
5611 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5612 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5613 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005614 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5615 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5616 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5617 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5618 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5619 break;
5620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5621 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5623 break;
5624 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005625 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005626 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005627 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005629 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5630 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5631 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5632 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5633
5634 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5635 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5636 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5637 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005638 break;
5639 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005640 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005641 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005642 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005644
5645 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5646 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5647 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5648 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5649
5650 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5651 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5652 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5653 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005654 break;
5655 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005656 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005657 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005658 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005660 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5661 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005662 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005663 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005664 break;
5665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005666 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005668 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005670
5671 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5672 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5673 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5674 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005675 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005676 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005677 }
5678
5679 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5680 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5681 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5682 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5683 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5684 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5685 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5686 if (I.hasOneUse())
5687 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5688 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5689 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5690 return 0;
5691
5692 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5693 // can be folded into the comparison.
5694 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005695 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005696 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005697 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005698 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005699 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5700 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005701 }
5702
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005703 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005704 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5705 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5706 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005707 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5708 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005709 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005710 bool isAllZeros = true;
5711 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5712 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5713 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5714 isAllZeros = false;
5715 break;
5716 }
5717 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005718 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005719 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5720 }
5721 break;
5722
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005723 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005724 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5725 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5726 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5727 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5728 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5729 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005730 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005731 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005732 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5733 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5734 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5735 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5736 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5737 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5738 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005739 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5740 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5741 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5742 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5743 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005744 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5745 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005746 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5747 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5748 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5749 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5750 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005751 }
5752 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005753
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005754 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005755 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005756 break;
5757 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005758 case Instruction::Malloc:
5759 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5760 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5761 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5762 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005764 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005765 }
5766 break;
5767 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005768 }
5769
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005770 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005771 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005772 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005773 return NI;
5774 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005775 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5776 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005777 return NI;
5778
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005779 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005780 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5781 // now.
5782 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5783 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5784 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005785 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5786 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005787 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005788
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005789 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5790 // so eliminate it as well.
5791 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5792 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005793
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005794 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005795 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005796 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005797 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005798 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005799 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005800 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005801 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005802 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005803 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005804 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005805 }
5806
5807 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005808 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005809 // This comes up when you have code like
5810 // int X = A < B;
5811 // if (X) ...
5812 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005813 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5814 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005815 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005816 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005817 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005818
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005819 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5820 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5821 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005822 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5823 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5824 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005825 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005826 default: break;
5827 case Instruction::Add:
5828 case Instruction::Sub:
5829 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005830 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5831 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5832 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005833 break;
5834 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005835 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5836 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5837 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5838 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5839 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5840 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5841 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5842 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005843 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005844 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5845 Mask);
5846 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5847 Mask);
5848 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5849 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5850 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005851 }
5852 }
5853 break;
5854 }
5855 }
5856 }
5857 }
5858
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005859 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5860 { Value *A, *B;
5861 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5862 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5863 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5864 }
5865
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005866 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005867 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005868
5869 // -x == -y --> x == y
5870 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5871 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5872 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5873
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005874 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5875 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5876 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5877 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5878 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5879 }
5880
5881 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5882 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5883 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5884 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5885 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005886 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005887 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005888 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5889 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5890 }
5891
5892 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5893 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5894 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5895 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5896 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5897 }
5898 }
5899
5900 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5901 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005902 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5903 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005904 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5905 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005906 }
5907 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005908 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005909 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5910 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005911 }
5912 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005913 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005914 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5915 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005916 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005917
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005918 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5919 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5920 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5921 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5922 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5923
5924 if (A == C) {
5925 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5926 } else if (A == D) {
5927 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5928 } else if (B == C) {
5929 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5930 } else if (B == D) {
5931 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5932 }
5933
5934 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005935 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5936 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005937 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5938 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5939 return &I;
5940 }
5941 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005942 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005943 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005944}
5945
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005946
5947/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5948/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5949Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5950 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5951 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5952 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5953
5954 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5955 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5956 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5957 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5958 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5959 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5960 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5961 // if it finds it.
5962 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5963 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5964 return 0;
5965 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005966 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005967 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
5968 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
5969 if (DivRHS->isOne())
5970 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
5971 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005972
5973 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5974 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5975 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5976 // instead of computing a divide.
5977 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5978
5979 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5980 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5981 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5982 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5983 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5984
5985 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005986 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005987
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005988 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5989 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5990 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5991 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5992 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5993 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5994 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5995 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5996 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5997
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005998 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005999 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006000 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006001 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6002 if (!HiOverflow)
6003 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006004 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006005 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006006 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006007 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6008 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006009 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006010 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6011 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6012 if (!HiOverflow)
6013 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006014 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006015 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006016 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006017 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6018 if (!LoOverflow) {
6019 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6020 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6021 true) ? -1 : 0;
6022 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006023 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006024 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006025 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006026 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006027 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6028 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006029 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6030 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6031 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6032 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006033 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006034 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006035 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006036 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006037 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006038 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006039 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006040 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6041 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006042 if (!HiOverflow)
6043 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006044 }
6045
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006046 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6047 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006048 }
6049
6050 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006051 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006052 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6053 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6054 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6055 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6056 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006057 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006058 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6059 else if (LoOverflow)
6060 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6061 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6062 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006063 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006064 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6065 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6067 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006068 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006069 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6070 else if (LoOverflow)
6071 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6072 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6073 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006074 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006075 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6076 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006077 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6079 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006081 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006082 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6083 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006084 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006085 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006086 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6087 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6088 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006089 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6090 else
6091 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6092 }
6093}
6094
6095
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006096/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6097///
6098Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6099 Instruction *LHSI,
6100 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6101 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6102
6103 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006104 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006105 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6106 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6107 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006108 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6109 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006110 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6111
6112 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6113 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6114 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6115 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6116 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6117 return &ICI;
6118 }
6119
6120 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6121 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6122
6123 // If so, the new one isn't.
6124 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6125
6126 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6127 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6128 else
6129 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6130 }
6131 }
6132 break;
6133 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6134 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6135 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6136 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6137
6138 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6139 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6140 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6141 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6142 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6143 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6144 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6145 // bit would not work.
6146 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006147 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6148 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006149 uint32_t BitWidth =
6150 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6151 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6152 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6153 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6154 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6155 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006156 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006157 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6158 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6159 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6160 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6161 }
6162 }
6163
6164 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6165 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6166 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6167 // access.
6168 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6169 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6170 Shift = 0;
6171
6172 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6173 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6174 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6175 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6176
6177 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6178 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6179 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6180 if (ShAmt) {
6181 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6182 if (!CanFold) {
6183 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6184 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6185 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6186 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6187
6188 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6189 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6190 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6191 CanFold = true;
6192 }
6193
6194 if (CanFold) {
6195 Constant *NewCst;
6196 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6197 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6198 else
6199 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6200
6201 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6202 // compared.
6203 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6204 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6205 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6206 // result is always true or false now.
6207 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6209 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6210 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6211 } else {
6212 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6213 Constant *NewAndCST;
6214 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6215 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6216 else
6217 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6218 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6219 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6220 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6221 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6222 return &ICI;
6223 }
6224 }
6225 }
6226
6227 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6228 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6229 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6230 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6231 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6232 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6233 // Compute C << Y.
6234 Value *NS;
6235 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006236 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006237 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6238 } else {
6239 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006240 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006241 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6242 }
6243 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6244
6245 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6246 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006247 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006248 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6249
6250 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6251 return &ICI;
6252 }
6253 }
6254 break;
6255
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006256 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6257 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6258 if (!ShAmt) break;
6259
6260 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6261
6262 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6263 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6264 // simplified.
6265 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6266 break;
6267
6268 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6269 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6270 // comparison cannot succeed.
6271 Constant *Comp =
6272 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6273 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6274 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6275 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6276 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6277 }
6278
6279 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6280 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6281 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6282 Constant *Mask =
6283 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006284
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006285 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006286 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006287 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6288 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6289 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6290 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006291 }
6292 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006293
6294 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6295 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6296 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6297 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6298 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6299 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6300 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6301 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006302 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006303 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6304 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6305
6306 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6307 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6308 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006309 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006310 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006311
6312 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006313 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006314 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006315 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006316 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006317
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006318 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6319 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6320 // simplified.
6321 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6322 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6323 break;
6324
6325 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006326
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006327 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6328 // comparison cannot succeed.
6329 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6330 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6331 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6332 else
6333 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6334
6335 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6336 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6337 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6339 }
6340
6341 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6342 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6343 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006344 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6345 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006346 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6347 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6348 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6349 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006350
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006351 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006352 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6353 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6354 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006355
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006356 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006357 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006358 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6359 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6360 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6361 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006362 }
6363 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006364 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006365
6366 case Instruction::SDiv:
6367 case Instruction::UDiv:
6368 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6369 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6370 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6371 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6372 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6373 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006374 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6375 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6376 DivRHS))
6377 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006378 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006379
6380 case Instruction::Add:
6381 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6382
6383 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6384 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6385 if (!LHSC) break;
6386 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6387
6388 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6389 .subtract(LHSV);
6390
6391 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6392 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6393 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6394 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6395 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6396 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6397 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6398 }
6399 } else {
6400 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6401 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6402 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6403 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6404 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6405 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6406 }
6407 }
6408 }
6409 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006410 }
6411
6412 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6413 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6414 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6415
6416 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6417 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6418 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6419 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6420 case Instruction::SRem:
6421 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6422 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6423 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6424 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6425 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006426 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006427 BO->getName());
6428 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6429 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6430 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6431 }
6432 }
6433 break;
6434 case Instruction::Add:
6435 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6436 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6437 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6438 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6439 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6440 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6441 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6442 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6443 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6444
6445 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6446 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6447 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6448 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6449 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006450 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006451 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6452 Neg->takeName(BO);
6453 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6454 }
6455 }
6456 break;
6457 case Instruction::Xor:
6458 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6459 // the explicit xor.
6460 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6461 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6462 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6463
6464 // FALLTHROUGH
6465 case Instruction::Sub:
6466 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6467 if (RHSV == 0)
6468 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6469 BO->getOperand(1));
6470 break;
6471
6472 case Instruction::Or:
6473 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6474 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6475 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6476 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6477 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6479 isICMP_NE));
6480 }
6481 break;
6482
6483 case Instruction::And:
6484 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6485 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6486 // comparison can never succeed!
6487 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6489 isICMP_NE));
6490
6491 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6492 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6493 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6494 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6495 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6496
6497 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006498 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006499 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6500 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6501 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6502 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6503 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6504 }
6505
6506 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6507 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6508 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6509 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6510 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6511 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6512 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6513 }
6514 }
6515 default: break;
6516 }
6517 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6518 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6519 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6520 AddToWorkList(II);
6521 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6522 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6523 return &ICI;
6524 }
6525 }
6526 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006527 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6528 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006529 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6530 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6531 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6532 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6533 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6534 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6535 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6536 // smaller constant values.
6537 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6538 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6539 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6540 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6541 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6542 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6543 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6544 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6545 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6546 }
6547 }
6548 }
6549 }
6550 return 0;
6551}
6552
6553/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6554/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6555///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006556Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6557 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006558 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6559 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006560 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006561 Value *RHSCIOp;
6562
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006563 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6564 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6565 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6566 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6567 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6568 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6569 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006570 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006571 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6572 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6573 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6574 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006575 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006576 }
6577
6578 if (RHSOp)
6579 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6580 }
6581
6582 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6583 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006584 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6585 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006586 return 0;
6587
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006588 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6589 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006590
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006591 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006592 // Not an extension from the same type?
6593 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006594 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6595 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006596
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006597 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006598 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6599 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6600 return 0;
6601
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006602 // Deal with equality cases early.
6603 if (ICI.isEquality())
6604 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6605
6606 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6607 // signed comparison.
6608 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6609 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6610
6611 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6612 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006613 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006614
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006615 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6616 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6617 if (!CI)
6618 return 0;
6619
6620 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6621 // reextended to DestTy.
6622 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6623 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6624
6625 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6626 if (Res2 == CI) {
6627 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6628 // For example, we might have:
6629 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6630 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6631 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6632 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6633 // because %A may have negative value.
6634 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006635 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6636 // signless.
6637 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006638 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006639 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006640 }
6641
6642 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6643 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6644
6645 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6646 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6647 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006649 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006650 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006651
6652 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6653 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6654 Value *Result;
6655 if (isSignedCmp) {
6656 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006657 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006658 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006659 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006660 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006661 } else {
6662 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6663 if (isSignedExt) {
6664 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6665 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006666 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006667 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6668 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6669 } else {
6670 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006671 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006672 }
6673 }
6674
6675 // Finally, return the value computed.
6676 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006677 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006679
6680 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6681 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6682 "ICmp should be folded!");
6683 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6684 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6685 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006686}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006687
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006688Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6689 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6690}
6691
6692Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6693 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6694}
6695
6696Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006697 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6698 return R;
6699
6700 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6701
6702 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6703 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6704 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6706
6707 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006708 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6709 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006710 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006711 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006712
6713 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006714}
6715
6716Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6717 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006718 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006719
6720 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6721 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006722 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006723 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006725
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006726 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6727 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006729 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6731 }
6732 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006733 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6735 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006737 }
6738
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006739 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6740 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6741 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006742 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006743 return R;
6744
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006745 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006746 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6747 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006748 return 0;
6749}
6750
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006751Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006752 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006753 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006754
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006755 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6756 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006757 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6758 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6759 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006760 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6761 return &I;
6762
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006763 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6764 // of a signed value.
6765 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006766 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006767 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6769 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006770 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006771 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006772 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006773 }
6774
6775 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6776 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6777 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6778 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006779 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006780 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6781
6782 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6783 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6784 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6785 return R;
6786 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6787 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6788 return NV;
6789
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006790 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6791 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6792 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6793 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6794 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6795 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6796 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6797 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6798 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6799 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6800 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6801 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006802 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006803 I.getName());
6804 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6805
6806 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6807 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6808 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6809 // other xforms later if dead.
6810 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6811 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6812 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6813
6814 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6815 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6816 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6817 // mask as appropriate.
6818 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6819 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6820 else {
6821 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6822 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6823 }
6824
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006825 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006826 TI->getName());
6827 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6828
6829 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6830 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6831 }
6832 }
6833
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006834 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006835 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6836 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6837 Value *V1, *V2;
6838 ConstantInt *CC;
6839 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006840 default: break;
6841 case Instruction::Add:
6842 case Instruction::And:
6843 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006844 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006845 // These operators commute.
6846 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006847 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6848 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006849 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006850 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006851 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006852 Op0BO->getName());
6853 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006854 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006855 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006856 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006857 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006858 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006859 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006860 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006861 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006862
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006863 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006864 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006865 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006866 match(Op0BOOp1,
6867 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006868 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6869 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006870 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006871 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6872 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006873 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6874 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006875 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006876 V1->getName()+".mask");
6877 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6878
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006879 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006880 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006881 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006882
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006883 // FALL THROUGH.
6884 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006885 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006886 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6887 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006888 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006889 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006890 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6891 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006892 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006893 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006894 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006895 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006896 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006897 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006898 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006899 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006900 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006901
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006902 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006903 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6904 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6905 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006906 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006907 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6908 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006909 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006910 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6911 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006912 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6913 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006914 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006915 V1->getName()+".mask");
6916 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6917
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006918 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006919 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006920
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006921 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006922 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006923 }
6924
6925
6926 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6927 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6928 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6929 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6930 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6931
6932 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006933 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006934 case Instruction::Add:
6935 isValid = isLeftShift;
6936 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006937 case Instruction::Or:
6938 case Instruction::Xor:
6939 highBitSet = false;
6940 break;
6941 case Instruction::And:
6942 highBitSet = true;
6943 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006944 }
6945
6946 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6947 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6948 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6949 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6950 // operation.
6951 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006952 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006953 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006954
6955 if (isValid) {
6956 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6957
6958 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006959 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006960 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006961 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006962
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006963 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006964 NewRHS);
6965 }
6966 }
6967 }
6968 }
6969
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006970 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006971 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6972 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6973 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006974
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006975 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006976 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006977 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6978 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006979 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6980 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6981 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006982
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006983 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006984 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6985 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006986
6987 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6988
6989 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006990 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006991 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006992 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6993 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6994 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6995 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006996 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006997 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6998 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6999 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7000 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007001 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007002 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7003
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007004 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007005 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007006 }
7007
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007008 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7009 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7010 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7011 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7012 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007013 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007014 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007015 }
7016 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7017 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007018 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007019 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007020 }
7021 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7022 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7023 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7024 // generators.
7025 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7026 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007027 case 1 :
7028 case 8 :
7029 case 16 :
7030 case 32 :
7031 case 64 :
7032 case 128:
7033 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7034 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007035 default: break;
7036 }
7037 if (SExtType) {
7038 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7039 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7040 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7041 }
7042 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7043 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007044 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007045
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007046 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007047 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7048 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7049 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007050 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007051 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007052 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7053
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007054 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007055 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007056 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007057
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007058 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007059 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7060 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7061 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007062 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007063 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007064
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007065 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007066 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007067 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007068
7069 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7070 } else {
7071 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007072 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007073
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007074 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007075 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7076 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7077 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7078 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007079 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007080 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7081 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7082
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007083 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007084 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007085 }
7086
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007087 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007088 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7089 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7090 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007091 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007092 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7093
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007094 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007095 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007096 }
7097
7098 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007099 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007100 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007101 return 0;
7102}
7103
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007104
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007105/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7106/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7107/// X*Scale+Offset.
7108///
7109static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007110 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007111 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007112 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007113 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007114 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007115 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007116 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7117 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7118 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7119 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7120 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7121 Offset = 0;
7122 return I->getOperand(0);
7123 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7124 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7125 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7126 Offset = 0;
7127 return I->getOperand(0);
7128 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7129 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7130 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7131 unsigned SubScale;
7132 Value *SubVal =
7133 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7134 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7135 Scale = SubScale;
7136 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007137 }
7138 }
7139 }
7140
7141 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7142 Scale = 1;
7143 Offset = 0;
7144 return Val;
7145}
7146
7147
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007148/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7149/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007150Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007151 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007152 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007153
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007154 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7155 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007156
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007157 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7158 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7159 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7160 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7161 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7162
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007163 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007164 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007165 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007166 }
7167 }
7168
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007169 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7170 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7171 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7172 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007173
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007174 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7175 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007176 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7177
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007178 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7179 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7180 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7181 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7182
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007183 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7184 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007185 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007186
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007187 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7188 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007189 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7190 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007191 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7192 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7193
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007194 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7195 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007196 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7197 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007198
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007199 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7200 Value *Amt = 0;
7201 if (Scale == 1) {
7202 Amt = NumElements;
7203 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007204 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007205 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7206 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007207 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007208 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007209 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007210 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007211 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007212 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007213 }
7214
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007215 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7216 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007217 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007218 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7219 }
7220
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007221 AllocationInst *New;
7222 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007223 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007224 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007225 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007226 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007227 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007228
7229 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7230 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7231 // die soon.
7232 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7233 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007234 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7235 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7236 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007237 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7238 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7239 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007240 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7241}
7242
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007243/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007244/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7245/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7246/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7247/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7248///
7249/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7250/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007251///
7252/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7253/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7254/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7255/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7256/// efficiently truncated.
7257///
7258/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7259/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7260/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007261bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7262 unsigned CastOpc,
7263 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007264 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7265 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7266 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007267
7268 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007269 if (!I) return false;
7270
7271 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007272
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007273 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7274 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7275 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7276 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7277 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7278 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7279 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7280 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007281 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007282 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7283 return true;
7284 }
7285 }
7286
7287 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7288 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7289 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7290
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007291 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007292 case Instruction::Add:
7293 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007294 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007295 case Instruction::And:
7296 case Instruction::Or:
7297 case Instruction::Xor:
7298 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007299 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7300 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7301 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7302 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007303
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007304 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007305 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7306 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7307 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007308 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7309 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7310 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007311 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7312 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007313 }
7314 break;
7315 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007316 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7317 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7318 // already zeros.
7319 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007320 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7321 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7322 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007323 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007324 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7325 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007326 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7327 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007328 }
7329 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007330 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007331 case Instruction::ZExt:
7332 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007333 case Instruction::Trunc:
7334 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007335 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7336 // of casts in the input.
7337 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007338 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007339 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007340 case Instruction::Select: {
7341 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7342 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7343 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7344 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7345 NumCastsRemoved);
7346 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007347 case Instruction::PHI: {
7348 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7349 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7350 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7351 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7352 NumCastsRemoved))
7353 return false;
7354 return true;
7355 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007356 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007357 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7358 break;
7359 }
7360
7361 return false;
7362}
7363
7364/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7365/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7366/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007367Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007368 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007369 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007370 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007371
7372 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7373 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007374 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007375 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007376 case Instruction::Add:
7377 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007378 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007379 case Instruction::And:
7380 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007381 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007382 case Instruction::AShr:
7383 case Instruction::LShr:
7384 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007385 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007386 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007387 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007388 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007389 break;
7390 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007391 case Instruction::Trunc:
7392 case Instruction::ZExt:
7393 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007394 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007395 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7396 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007397 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7398 return I->getOperand(0);
7399
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007400 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007401 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007402 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007403 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007404 case Instruction::Select: {
7405 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7406 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7407 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7408 break;
7409 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007410 case Instruction::PHI: {
7411 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7412 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7413 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7414 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7415 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7416 }
7417 Res = NPN;
7418 break;
7419 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007420 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007421 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7422 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7423 break;
7424 }
7425
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007426 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007427 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7428}
7429
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007430/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7431Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007432 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7433
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007434 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007435 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007436 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007437 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7438 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7439 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7440 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007441 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007442 }
7443 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007444
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007445 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007446 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7447 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7448 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007449
7450 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007451 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7452 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7453 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007454
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007455 return 0;
7456}
7457
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007458/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7459Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7460 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7461
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007462 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007463 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7464 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007465 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7466 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7467 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7468 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007469 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007470 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7471 return &CI;
7472 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007473
7474 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7475 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7476 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7477 // non-type-safe code.
7478 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7479 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7480 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7481 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7482 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7483
7484 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7485 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7486 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7487 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7488 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7489 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7490
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007491 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7492 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7493 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007494 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007495 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007496 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007497 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7498 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007499
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007500 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7501 if (Offset < 0) {
7502 --FirstIdx;
7503 Offset += TySize;
7504 assert(Offset >= 0);
7505 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007506 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007507 }
7508
7509 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007510
7511 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7512 while (Offset) {
7513 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7514 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007515 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7516 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7517 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007518
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007519 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7520 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7521 } else {
7522 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7523 Offset = 0;
7524 OrigBase = 0;
7525 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007526 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7527 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007528 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007529 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7530 Offset %= EltSize;
7531 } else {
7532 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7533 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007534 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7535 } else {
7536 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7537 Offset = 0;
7538 OrigBase = 0;
7539 }
7540 }
7541 if (OrigBase) {
7542 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7543 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7544 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007545 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7546 NewIndices.begin(),
7547 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007548 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7549 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7550
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007551 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7552 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7553 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7554 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7555 }
7556 }
7557 }
7558 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007559 }
7560
7561 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7562}
7563
7564
7565
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007566/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7567/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007568/// cases.
7569/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7570Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7571 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7572 return Result;
7573
7574 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7575 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7576 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007577 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7578 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007579
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007580 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7581 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007582 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7583 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007584 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7585 return &CI;
7586
7587 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7588 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007589 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7590 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007591 return 0;
7592
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007593 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007594 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007595 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7596 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007597 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007598 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007599 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7600 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7601 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7602 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007603 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007604 bool DoXForm;
7605 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7606 default:
7607 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7608 // get here because of the check above.
7609 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7610 case Instruction::Trunc:
7611 DoXForm = true;
7612 break;
7613 case Instruction::ZExt:
7614 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7615 break;
7616 case Instruction::SExt:
7617 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7618 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007619 }
7620
7621 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007622 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7623 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007624 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7625 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7626 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7627 case Instruction::Trunc:
7628 case Instruction::BitCast:
7629 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7630 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7631 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7632 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7633 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007634 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7635 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007636 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007637 }
7638 case Instruction::SExt:
7639 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007640 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007641 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7642 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007643 }
7644 }
7645 }
7646
7647 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7648 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7649
7650 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7651 case Instruction::Add:
7652 case Instruction::Mul:
7653 case Instruction::And:
7654 case Instruction::Or:
7655 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007656 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007657 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7658 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7659 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7660 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7661 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007662 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7663 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007664 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007665 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7666 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007667 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007668 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007669 }
7670 }
7671
7672 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7673 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7674 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007675 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007676 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007677 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007678 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007679 }
7680 break;
7681 case Instruction::SDiv:
7682 case Instruction::UDiv:
7683 case Instruction::SRem:
7684 case Instruction::URem:
7685 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7686 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7687 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7688 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7689 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007690 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7691 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007692 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7693 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7694 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7695 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007696 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007697 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7698 }
7699 }
7700 break;
7701
7702 case Instruction::Shl:
7703 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7704 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7705 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7706 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7707 // in the value.
7708 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7709 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007710 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7711 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7712 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007713 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007714 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007715 }
7716 break;
7717 case Instruction::AShr:
7718 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7719 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7720 // simplifications.
7721 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7722 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007723 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007724 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7725 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007726 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007727 }
7728 }
7729 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007730 }
7731 return 0;
7732}
7733
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007734Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007735 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7736 return Result;
7737
7738 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7739 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007740 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7741 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007742
7743 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7744 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7745 default: break;
7746 case Instruction::LShr:
7747 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7748 // are already zeros.
7749 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007750 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007751
7752 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007753 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007754 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7755 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007756 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7758
7759 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7760 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007761 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7762 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7763 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007764 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007765 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007766 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7767
7768 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7769 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7770 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007771 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007772 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7773
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007774 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007775 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007776 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007777 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007778 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7779 "tmp"), CI);
7780 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007781 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007782 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007783 }
7784 break;
7785 }
7786 }
7787
7788 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007789}
7790
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007791/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7792/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7793Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7794 bool DoXform) {
7795 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7796 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7797 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7798 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7799 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7800
7801 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7802 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7803 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7804 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7805 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7806
7807 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7808 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7809 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007810 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007811 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7812 CI);
7813 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007814 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007815 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7816
7817 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7818 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007819 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007820 In->getName()+".not"),
7821 CI);
7822 }
7823
7824 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7825 }
7826
7827
7828
7829 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7830 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7831 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7832 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7833 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7834 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7835 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7836 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7837 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7838 // This only works for EQ and NE
7839 ICI->isEquality()) {
7840 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7841 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7842 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7843 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7844 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7845
7846 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7847 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7848 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7849
7850 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7851 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7852 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7853 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7854 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7855 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7857 }
7858
7859 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7860 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7861 if (ShiftAmt) {
7862 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7863 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007864 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007865 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7866 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7867 }
7868
7869 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7870 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007871 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007872 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7873 }
7874
7875 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7877 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007878 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007879 }
7880 }
7881 }
7882
7883 return 0;
7884}
7885
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007886Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007887 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7888 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7889 return Result;
7890
7891 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7892
7893 // If this is a cast of a cast
7894 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007895 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7896 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7897 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7898 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7899 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7900 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007901 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7902 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7903 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007904 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7905 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7906 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007907 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007908 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007909 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007910 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007911 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7912 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7913 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7914 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007915 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007916 }
7917 return And;
7918 }
7919 }
7920 }
7921
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007922 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7923 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007924
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007925 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7926 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7927 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7928 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7929 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7930 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7931 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7932 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7933 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7934 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7935 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007936 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007937 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007938 }
7939
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007940 return 0;
7941}
7942
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007943Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007944 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7945 return I;
7946
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007947 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7948
7949 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7950 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7951 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7952 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7953 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7954 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7955 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7956 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7957
7958 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7959 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7960 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7961 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7962 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7963 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7964 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007965 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007966 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007967 CI);
7968 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007969 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007970 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7971
7972 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007973 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007974 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7975
7976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7977 }
7978 }
7979 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007980
7981 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7982 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7983 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7984 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7985 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7986 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7987 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7988 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7989
7990 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7991 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7992 // bits, it is already ready.
7993 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7995 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7996 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7997 // bits, just sext from i32.
7998 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7999 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8000 } else {
8001 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8002 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8003 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8004 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8005 }
8006 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008007
8008 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8009 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8010 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8011 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8012 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8013 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8014 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8015 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8016 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8017 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8018 // into:
8019 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8020 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8021 Value *A = 0;
8022 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8023 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8024 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8025 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8026 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8027 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8028 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8029 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8030 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8031 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8032 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8033 CI.getName()), CI);
8034 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8035 }
8036 }
8037
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008038 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039}
8040
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008041/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8042/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008043static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008044 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008045 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008046 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8047 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008048 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008049 return 0;
8050}
8051
8052/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8053/// through it until we get the source value.
8054static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8055 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8056 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8057 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8058
8059 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8060 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8061 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8062 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8063 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8064 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8065 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008066 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008067 return V;
8068 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8069 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008070 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008071 return V;
8072 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8073 }
8074
8075 return V;
8076}
8077
8078Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8079 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8080 return I;
8081
8082 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8083 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8084 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8085 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8086 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8087 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8088 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8089 default: break;
8090 case Instruction::Add:
8091 case Instruction::Sub:
8092 case Instruction::Mul:
8093 case Instruction::FDiv:
8094 case Instruction::FRem:
8095 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8096 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8097 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8098 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8099 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8100 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8101 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8102 // the cast, do this xform.
8103 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8104 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8105 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8106 CI.getType(), CI);
8107 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8108 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008109 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008110 }
8111 }
8112 break;
8113 }
8114 }
8115 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008116}
8117
8118Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8119 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8120}
8121
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008122Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008123 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8124 if (OpI == 0)
8125 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8126
8127 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8128 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8129 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8130 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8131 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8132 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8133 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8134 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8135 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8136 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8137 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008138
8139 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008140}
8141
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008142Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008143 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8144 if (OpI == 0)
8145 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8146
8147 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8148 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8149 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8150 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8151 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8152 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8153 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8154 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8155 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8156 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008158
8159 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008160}
8161
8162Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8163 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8164}
8165
8166Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8167 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8168}
8169
8170Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008171 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008172}
8173
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008174Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8175 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8176 return I;
8177
8178 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8179 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8180
8181 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8182 ConstantInt *Cst;
8183 Value *X;
8184 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8185 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8186 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8187 // is a single-index GEP.
8188 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8189 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008190 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008191
8192 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8193 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8194 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8195
8196 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8197 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8198 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008199 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008200 }
8201 }
8202 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8203 // struct etc.
8204 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8205 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8206 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8207 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8208
8209 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8210 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8211
8212 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8213 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8214 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8215
8216 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8217 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8218 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8219
8220 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8221 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008222 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008223 }
8224 }
8225 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008226}
8227
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008228Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008229 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8230 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8231 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8232 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8233 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8234
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008235 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008236 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8237 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008238 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8239 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8240 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008241 } else {
8242 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8243 return Result;
8244 }
8245
8246
8247 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8248 // be replaced by the operand.
8249 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8251
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008252 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008253 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8254 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8255 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8256
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008257 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8258 // required for changing types.
8259 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8260 return 0;
8261
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008262 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8263 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8264 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8265 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8266 return V;
8267
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008268 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8269 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008270 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8271 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8272 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8273 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8274 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8275 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8276 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8277 ++NumZeros;
8278 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008279
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008280 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8281 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8282 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008283 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8284 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008285 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008286 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008287
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008288 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8289 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8290 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8291 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008292 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
8293 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008294 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
8295 CastInst *Tmp;
8296 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8297 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8298 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8299 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8300 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8301 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8302 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008303 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8304 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8305 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8306 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008307 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8308 // know the vector types match #elts.
8309 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008310 }
8311 }
8312 }
8313 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008314 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008315}
8316
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008317/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8318/// %C = or %A, %B
8319/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8320/// into:
8321/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8322/// %D = or %A, %C
8323///
8324/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8325/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8326/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8327///
8328static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8329 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8330 case Instruction::Add:
8331 case Instruction::Mul:
8332 case Instruction::And:
8333 case Instruction::Or:
8334 case Instruction::Xor:
8335 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8336 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8337 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008338 case Instruction::LShr:
8339 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008340 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008341 default:
8342 return 0; // Cannot fold
8343 }
8344}
8345
8346/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8347/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8348static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8349 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8350 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8351 case Instruction::Add:
8352 case Instruction::Sub:
8353 case Instruction::Or:
8354 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008355 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008356 case Instruction::LShr:
8357 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008358 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008359 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008360 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008361 case Instruction::Mul:
8362 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8363 }
8364}
8365
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008366/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8367/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8368Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8369 Instruction *FI) {
8370 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8371 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8372 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008373 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008374 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8375 return 0;
8376 } else {
8377 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8378 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008379
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008380 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008381 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8382 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008383 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008384 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008385 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008386 }
8387
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008388 // Only handle binary operators here.
8389 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008390 return 0;
8391
8392 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8393 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8394 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8395 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8396 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8397 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8398 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8399 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8400 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8401 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8402 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8403 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8404 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8405 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8406 return 0;
8407 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8408 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8409 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8410 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8411 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8412 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8413 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8414 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8415 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8416 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8417 } else {
8418 return 0;
8419 }
8420
8421 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008422 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8423 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008424 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8425
8426 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8427 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008428 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008429 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008430 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008431 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008432 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8433 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008434}
8435
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008436/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8437/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8438///
8439Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8440 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8441 bool Changed = false;
8442 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8443 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8444 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8445 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8446 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8447
8448 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8449 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8450 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8451 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
8452 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS))
8453 switch (Pred) {
8454 default: break;
8455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8456 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8457 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8458 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8460 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8461 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8462 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8463 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8464 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8465 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8466 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8467 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8468 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8469 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8470 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8471 Changed = true;
8472 }
8473 break;
8474 }
8475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8476 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8477 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8478 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8480 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8481 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8482 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8483 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8484 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8485 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8486 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8487 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8488 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8489 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8490 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8491 Changed = true;
8492 }
8493 break;
8494 }
8495 }
8496
8497 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8498 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8499 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8501 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8502 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8503 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8504 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8505
8506 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8507 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8508 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8510 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8511 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8512 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8513 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8514 }
8515
8516 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8517
8518 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8519}
8520
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008521Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008522 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8523 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8524 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8525
8526 // select true, X, Y -> X
8527 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008528 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008530
8531 // select C, X, X -> X
8532 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8534
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008535 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8537 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8539 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8540 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8542 else
8543 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8544 }
8545
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008546 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008547 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008548 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008549 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008550 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008551 } else {
8552 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8553 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008554 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008555 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008556 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008557 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008558 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008559 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008560 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008561 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008562 } else {
8563 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8564 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008565 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008566 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008567 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008568 }
8569 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008570
8571 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8572 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8573 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008574 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008575 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008576 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008577 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008578
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008579 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8580 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8581 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008582 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008583 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008584 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008585 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008586 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008587 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008588 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008589 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008590 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008591 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008592
8593 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008594
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008595 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008596
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008597 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008598 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008599 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008600 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008601 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008602 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008603 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008604 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008605 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008606 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008607 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008608 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8609
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008610 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8611 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8612 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008613 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8614 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008615 if (SRASize < SISize)
8616 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8617 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8618 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008619 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008620 }
8621 }
8622
8623
8624 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008625 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008626 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8627 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008628 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008629 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008630 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8631 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8632 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008633 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8634 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8635 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008636 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8637 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008638 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8639 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008640 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008641 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008642 Value *V = ICA;
8643 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008644 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008645 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8646 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8647 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008648 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008649 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008650
8651 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008652 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8653 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008654 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008655 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8656 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8657 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8658 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8659 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8660 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8661 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8662 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8663 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008665 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008666 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008667 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008669 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008670
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008671 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008672 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008673 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8674 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8675 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8676 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8677 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8678 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8679 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8680 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8681 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8683 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008684 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008685 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008687 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008688 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008689 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008690 }
8691
8692 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008693 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8694 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8695 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008696
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008697 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8698 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8699 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008700 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8701
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008702 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8703 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8704 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8705 return IV;
8706
8707 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8708 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008709 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8710 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8711 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8712 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8713 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8714 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8715 }
8716
8717 if (AddOp) {
8718 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8719 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8720 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8721 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8722 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8723 }
8724
8725 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008726 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8727 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8728 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8729 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8730 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8731 } else {
8732 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008733 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008734 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008735
8736 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8737 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8738 if (AddOp != TI)
8739 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8740 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008741 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8742 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008743
8744 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008745 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008746 }
8747 }
8748 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008749
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008750 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008751 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008752 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8753 // transformation we are doing here.
8754 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8755 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8756 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8757 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8758 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8759 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8760 OpToFold = 1;
8761 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8762 OpToFold = 2;
8763 }
8764
8765 if (OpToFold) {
8766 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008767 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008768 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8769 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008770 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008771 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008772 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008773 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008774 else {
8775 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8776 }
8777 }
8778 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008779
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008780 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8781 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8782 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8783 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8784 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8785 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8786 OpToFold = 1;
8787 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8788 OpToFold = 2;
8789 }
8790
8791 if (OpToFold) {
8792 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008793 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008794 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8795 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008796 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008797 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008798 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008799 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008800 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008801 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008802 }
8803 }
8804 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008805
8806 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8807 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8808 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8809 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8810 return &SI;
8811 }
8812
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008813 return 0;
8814}
8815
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008816/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8817/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8818/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8819/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8820/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8821///
8822static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8823 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008824
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008825 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8826 if (!U) return Align;
8827
8828 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8829 default: break;
8830 case Instruction::BitCast:
8831 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8832 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008833 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8834 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008835 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008836 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8837 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008838 AllZeroOperands = false;
8839 break;
8840 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008841
8842 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8843 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008844 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008845 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008846 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008847 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008848 }
8849
8850 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8851 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8852 // of the global.
8853 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8854 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8855 Align = PrefAlign;
8856 }
8857 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8858 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8859 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8860 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8861 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8862 Align = PrefAlign;
8863 }
8864 }
8865
8866 return Align;
8867}
8868
8869/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8870/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8871/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8872/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8873unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8874 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8875 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8876 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8877 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8878 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8879 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8880 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8881 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8882
8883 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8884 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8885
8886 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8887 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008888}
8889
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008890Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008891 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8892 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008893 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8894 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8895
8896 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8897 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8898 return MI;
8899 }
8900
8901 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8902 // load/store.
8903 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8904 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8905
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008906 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8907 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8908 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8909 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008910 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008911 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8912
8913 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008914 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008915
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008916 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008917 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008918
8919 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8920 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8921 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8922 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8923 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8924 // integer datatype.
8925 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8926 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8927 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8928 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8929 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008930 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008931 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8932 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8933 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8934 else
8935 break;
8936 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8937 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8938 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8939 else
8940 break;
8941 } else
8942 break;
8943 }
8944
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008945 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008946 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8947 }
8948 }
8949
8950
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008951 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8952 // infer, use it.
8953 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8954 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8955
8956 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8957 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008958 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8959 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8960 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8961
8962 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8963 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8964 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008965}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008966
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008967Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8968 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8969 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8970 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8971 return MI;
8972 }
8973
8974 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8975 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8976 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8977 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8978 return 0;
8979 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8980 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8981
8982 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8983 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8984
8985 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8986 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8987 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8988
8989 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8990 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8991
8992 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8993 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8994
8995 // Extract the fill value and store.
8996 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8997 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8998 Alignment), *MI);
8999
9000 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9001 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9002 return MI;
9003 }
9004
9005 return 0;
9006}
9007
9008
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009009/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9010/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9011/// the heavy lifting.
9012///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009013Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009014 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9015 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9016
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009017 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9018 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009019 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009020 bool Changed = false;
9021
9022 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9023 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9024 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9025
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009026 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009027 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009028 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9029 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9030 // alignment is sufficient.
9031 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009032 }
9033
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009034 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9035 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9036 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009037 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009038 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9039 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9040 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009041 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9042 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9043 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009044 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009045 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9046 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009047 Changed = true;
9048 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009049
9050 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9051 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9052 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009053 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009054
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009055 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9056 // set, update the alignment.
9057 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009058 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9059 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009060 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9061 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9062 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009063 }
9064
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009065 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009066 }
9067
9068 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9069 default: break;
9070 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9071 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9072 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9073 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9075 break;
9076 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9077 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9078 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9079 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9080 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9081 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9082 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9083 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9084 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9085 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9086 CI);
9087 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009088 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009089 break;
9090 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9091 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9092 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9093 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9094 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9095 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9096 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9097 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9098 }
9099 break;
9100 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9101 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9102 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009103 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9104 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9105 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9106 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9107 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9108 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9109 }
9110 break;
9111
9112 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9113 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9114 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9115 uint64_t UndefElts;
9116 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9117 UndefElts)) {
9118 II->setOperand(1, V);
9119 return II;
9120 }
9121 break;
9122 }
9123
9124 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9125 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9126 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9127 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009128
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009129 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9130 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9131 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9132 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9133 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9134 AllEltsOk = false;
9135 break;
9136 }
9137 }
9138
9139 if (AllEltsOk) {
9140 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9141 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9142 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9143 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009144
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009145 // Only extract each element once.
9146 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9147 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9148
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009149 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009150 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9151 continue;
9152 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9153 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9154
9155 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9156 Instruction *Elt =
9157 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9158 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9159 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009160 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009161
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009162 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9163 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9164 i, "tmp");
9165 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009166 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009167 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009168 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009169 }
9170 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009171
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009172 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9173 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9174 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9175 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9176 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9177 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9178 if (&*++BI == II)
9179 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009180 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009181 }
9182
9183 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9184 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9185 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9186 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9187 bool CannotRemove = false;
9188 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9189 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9190 CannotRemove = true;
9191 break;
9192 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009193 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9194 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9195 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9196 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9197 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9198 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9199 } else {
9200 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9201 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009202 CannotRemove = true;
9203 break;
9204 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009205 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009206 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009207
9208 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9209 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9210 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9211 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9212 break;
9213 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009214 }
9215
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009216 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009217}
9218
9219// InvokeInst simplification
9220//
9221Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009222 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009223}
9224
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009225/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9226/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009227static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9228 const CastInst * const CI,
9229 const TargetData * const TD,
9230 const int ix) {
9231 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9232 return false;
9233
9234 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9235 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9236 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009237 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009238 return true;
9239
9240 const Type* SrcTy =
9241 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9242 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9243 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9244 return false;
9245 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9246 return false;
9247 return true;
9248}
9249
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009250// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9251//
9252Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009253 bool Changed = false;
9254
9255 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9256 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009257 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9258
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009259 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009260
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009261 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9262 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9263 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9264 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9265 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009266 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009267 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9268 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009269 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9270 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9271 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9272 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9273 return 0;
9274 }
9275
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009276 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9277 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9278 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9279 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009280 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009281 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009282 CS.getInstruction());
9283
9284 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9285 CS.getInstruction()->
9286 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9287
9288 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9289 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009290 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9291 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009292 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009293 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9294 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009295
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009296 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9297 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9298 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9299 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9300
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009301 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9302 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9303 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009304 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009305 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9306 // the call.
9307 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009308 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9309 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9310 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9311 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9312 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009313 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009314 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009315 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009316
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009317 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009318 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009319 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009320 Changed = true;
9321 }
9322
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009323 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009324}
9325
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009326// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9327// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9328//
9329bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9330 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9331 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009332 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9333 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009334 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009335 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009336 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009337 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009338
9339 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9340 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9341 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9342 //
9343 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9344 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009345 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009346
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009347 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009348 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9349
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009350 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009351 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009352 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009353 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9354 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9355 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009356 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009357 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009358
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009359 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009360 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009361 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009362 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9363
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009364 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009365 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009366 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009367 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9368 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009369
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009370 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9371 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9372 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9373 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9374 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9375 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9376 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9377 UI != E; ++UI)
9378 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9379 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009380 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009381 return false;
9382 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009383
9384 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9385 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009386
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009387 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9388 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9389 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009390 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009391
9392 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009393 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9394
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009395 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9396 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009397 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009398
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009399 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9400 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009401 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009402 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9403 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009404 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009405 }
9406
9407 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009408 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009409 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009410
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009411 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9412 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009413 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009414 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9415 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009416 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9417 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009418 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009419 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009420 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009421 return false;
9422 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009423
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009424 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9425 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9426 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9427 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009428 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009429 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9430
9431 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009432 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009433
9434 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9435 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009436 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009437
9438 // Add the new return attributes.
9439 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009440 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009441
9442 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9443 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9444 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9445 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9446 Args.push_back(*AI);
9447 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009448 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009449 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009450 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009451 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009452 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009453
9454 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009455 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009456 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009457 }
9458
9459 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9460 // now...
9461 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9462 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9463
9464 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009465 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009466 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009467 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9468 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009469 } else {
9470 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9471 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9472 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9473 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9474 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009475 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9476 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009477 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009478 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9479 Args.push_back(Cast);
9480 } else {
9481 Args.push_back(*AI);
9482 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009483
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009484 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009485 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009486 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009487 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009488 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009489 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009490
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009491 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9492 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9493
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009494 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009495 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009496
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009497 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009498
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009499 Instruction *NC;
9500 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009501 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009502 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9503 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009504 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009505 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009506 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009507 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9508 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009509 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9510 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009511 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009512 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009513 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009514 }
9515
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009516 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009517 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009518 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009519 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009520 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009521 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009522 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009523
9524 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9525 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9526 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009527 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009528 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9529 } else {
9530 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9531 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9532 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009533 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009534 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009535 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009536 }
9537 }
9538
9539 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9540 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009541 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009542 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009543 return true;
9544}
9545
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009546// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9547// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9548//
9549Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9550 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9551 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9552 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009553 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009554
9555 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9556 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009557 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009558 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009559
9560 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9561 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9562
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009563 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009564 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9565 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9566
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009567 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009568 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009569 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9570 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009571 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009572
9573 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9574 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9575 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009576 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009577 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9578 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009579 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009580 break;
9581 }
9582
9583 if (NestTy) {
9584 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9585 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9586 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9587
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009588 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009589 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009590
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009591 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009592 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9593
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009594 // Add any result attributes.
9595 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009596 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009597
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009598 {
9599 unsigned Idx = 1;
9600 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9601 do {
9602 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009603 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009604 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9605 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9606 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9607 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009608 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009609 }
9610
9611 if (I == E)
9612 break;
9613
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009614 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009615 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009616 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009617 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009618 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009619
9620 ++Idx, ++I;
9621 } while (1);
9622 }
9623
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009624 // Add any function attributes.
9625 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9626 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9627
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009628 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9629 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009630 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009631
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009632 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009633 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9634
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009635 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009636 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009637 {
9638 unsigned Idx = 1;
9639 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9640 E = FTy->param_end();
9641
9642 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009643 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9644 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009645 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009646
9647 if (I == E)
9648 break;
9649
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009650 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009651 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009652
9653 ++Idx, ++I;
9654 } while (1);
9655 }
9656
9657 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9658 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9659 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009660 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009661 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9662 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009663 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009664
9665 Instruction *NewCaller;
9666 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009667 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9668 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9669 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9670 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009671 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009672 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009673 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009674 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9675 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009676 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9677 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9678 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9679 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009680 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009681 }
9682 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9683 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9684 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9685 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9686 return 0;
9687 }
9688 }
9689
9690 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9691 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9692 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9693 Constant *NewCallee =
9694 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9695 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9696 return CS.getInstruction();
9697}
9698
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009699/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9700/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9701/// and a single binop.
9702Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9703 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009704 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9705 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009706 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009707 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9708 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9709
9710 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9711 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009712
9713 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9714 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009715 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009716 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009717 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009718 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009719 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9720 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9721 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009722 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009723
9724 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9725 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9726 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9727 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9728 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009729
9730 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9731 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9732 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009733 }
9734
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009735 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9736
9737 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9738 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9739 // hide them behind a phi.
9740 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9741 return 0;
9742
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009743 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009744 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009745 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009746 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009747 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9748 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009749 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9750 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009751 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9752 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9753 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009754
9755 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009756 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9757 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009758 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9759 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009760 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9761 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9762 }
9763
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009764 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9765 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9766 if (NewLHS) {
9767 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9768 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9769 }
9770 if (NewRHS) {
9771 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9772 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9773 }
9774 }
9775
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009776 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009777 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009778 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009779 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009780 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009781 else {
9782 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009783 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009784 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009785}
9786
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009787/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9788/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9789/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9790/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009791///
9792/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9793/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9794/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009795static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9796 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9797
9798 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9799 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9800 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009801
9802 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9803 // profitable to do this xform.
9804 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9805 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9806 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9807 UI != E; ++UI) {
9808 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9809 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9810 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9811 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9812 }
9813 isAddressTaken = true;
9814 break;
9815 }
9816
9817 if (!isAddressTaken)
9818 return false;
9819 }
9820
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009821 return true;
9822}
9823
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009824
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009825// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9826// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9827// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9828Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9829 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9830
9831 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9832 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9833 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9834 // code size and simplifying code.
9835 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9836 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009837 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009838 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9839 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009840 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009841 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9842 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009843 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009844 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9845 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009846 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9847 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9848 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9849 // load and the PHI.
9850 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9851 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9852 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009853
9854 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9855 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9856 // the path through the other successor.
9857 if (isVolatile &&
9858 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9859 return 0;
9860
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009861 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009862 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009863 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9864 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9865 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009866 } else {
9867 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9868 }
9869
9870 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9871 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9872 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9873 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009874 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009875 return 0;
9876 if (CastSrcTy) {
9877 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9878 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009879 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009880 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9881 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009882 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9883 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9884 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9885 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009886
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009887 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9888 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9889 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009890 if (isVolatile &&
9891 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9892 return 0;
9893
9894
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009895 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9896 return 0;
9897 }
9898 }
9899
9900 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9901 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009902 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9903 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009904 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009905
9906 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9907 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009908
9909 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009910 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9911 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9912 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9913 InVal = 0;
9914 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9915 }
9916
9917 Value *PhiVal;
9918 if (InVal) {
9919 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9920 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9921 PhiVal = InVal;
9922 delete NewPN;
9923 } else {
9924 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9925 PhiVal = NewPN;
9926 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009927
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009928 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009929 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009930 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009931 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009932 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009933 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009934 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009935 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009936 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9937
9938 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9939 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9940 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9941 if (isVolatile)
9942 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9943 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9944
9945 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009946}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009947
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009948/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9949/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009950static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9951 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009952 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9953 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9954
9955 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009956 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009957 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009958
9959 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9960 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9961 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009962
9963 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9964 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009965
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009966 return false;
9967}
9968
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009969/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9970/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9971/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9972static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9973 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9974 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9975 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9976 return true;
9977
9978 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9979 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9980 return false;
9981
9982 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9983 // the value.
9984 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9985 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9986 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9987 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9988 return false;
9989 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9990 return false;
9991 }
9992
9993 return true;
9994}
9995
9996
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009997// PHINode simplification
9998//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010000 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010001 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010002
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010003 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10005
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010006 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10007 // reducing code size.
10008 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10009 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10010 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10011 return Result;
10012
10013 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10014 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10015 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010016 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10017 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10018 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010019 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010020 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10021 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10022 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10023 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010024
10025 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10026 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10027 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10028 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10029 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10030 // late.
10031 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10032 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10033 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10034 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10035 }
10036 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010037
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010038 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10039 // same value, for example:
10040 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10041 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10042 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10043 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10044 {
10045 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10046 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10047 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10048 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10049 ++InValNo;
10050
10051 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10052 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10053
10054 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10055 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10056 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10057 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10058 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10059 break;
10060 }
10061
10062 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10063 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10064 // the value.
10065 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10066 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10067 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10068 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10069 }
10070 }
10071 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010072 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010073}
10074
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010075static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10076 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10077 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010078 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10079 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010080 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10081 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10082 // used for address computation.
10083 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10084 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10085 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10086 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010087}
10088
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010089
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010090Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010091 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010092 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010093 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010094 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010096
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010097 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10098 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10099
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010100 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10101 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10102 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10103
10104 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010106
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010107 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10108 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010109
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010110 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010111 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10112 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010113 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010114 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010115 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10116 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10117 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10118 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10119 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10120 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10121 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010122 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010123 }
10124 }
10125 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010126 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010127 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10128 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010129 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10130 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010131 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010132 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010133 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010134 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010135 MadeChange = true;
10136 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010137 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10138 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010139 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010140 MadeChange = true;
10141 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010142 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10143 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10144 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10145 MadeChange = true;
10146 } else {
10147 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10148 GEP);
10149 *i = Op;
10150 MadeChange = true;
10151 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010152 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010153 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010154 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010155 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10156
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010157 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10158 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10159 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010160 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10161 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10162 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10163 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10164 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10165 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010166 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10167 if (I != BCI) {
10168 I->takeName(BCI);
10169 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10170 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10171 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010172 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010173 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010174 }
10175 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10176 }
10177 }
10178
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010179 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10180 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10181 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10182 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010183 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010184 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010185 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010186
10187 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010188 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10189 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10190 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10191 //
10192 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10193 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10194 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10195
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010196 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010197
10198 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10199 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10200 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10201 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010202 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010203
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010204 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010205 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010206 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10207 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10208 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010209 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010210 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10211 Sum = GO1;
10212 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10213 Sum = SO1;
10214 } else {
10215 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10216 // target's pointer size.
10217 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10218 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010219 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010220 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010221 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010222 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010223 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10224 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010225 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010226 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010227
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010228 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010229 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010230 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010231 } else {
10232 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010233 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10234 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010235 }
10236 }
10237 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010238 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10239 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10240 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010241 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010242 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010243 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010244 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010245
10246 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10247 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10248 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10249 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10250 return &GEP;
10251 } else {
10252 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10253 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10254 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10255 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10256 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010257 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010258 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010259 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010260 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010261 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10262 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010263 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10264 }
10265
10266 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010267 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10268 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010269
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010270 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010271 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10272 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10273
10274 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010275 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010276 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10277 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10278 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10279
10280 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010281 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10282 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010283
10284 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10285 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10286 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010287 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010288 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10289 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10290 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010291 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10292 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010293 //
10294 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10295 //
10296 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10297 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10298 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10299 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10300 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10301 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10302 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10303 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10304 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10305 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10306 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10307 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10308 return &GEP;
10309 }
10310 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10311 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010312 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10313 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010314 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10315 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10316 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010317 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10318 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010319 Value *Idx[2];
10320 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10321 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010322 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010323 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010324 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10325 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010326 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010327
10328 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010329 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010330 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010331 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010332
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010333 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010334 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010335 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010336
10337 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10338 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10339 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10340 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10341 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10342 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10343 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10344 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010345 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010346 Scale = CI;
10347 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10348 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10349 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010350 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10351 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10352 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010353 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10354 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10355 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10356 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10357 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10358 }
10359 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010360
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010361 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010362 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10363 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10364 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10365 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10366 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10367 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10368 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010369 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010370 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010371 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010372 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010373 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10374 }
10375
10376 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010377 Value *Idx[2];
10378 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10379 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010380 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010381 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010382 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10383 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10384 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010385 }
10386 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010387 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010388 }
10389
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010390 return 0;
10391}
10392
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010393Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10394 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010395 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010396 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10397 const Type *NewTy =
10398 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010399 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010400
10401 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10402 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010403 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010404 else {
10405 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010406 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010407 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010408
10409 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010410
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010411 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10412 // allocas if possible...
10413 //
10414 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10415 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10416
10417 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10418 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10419 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010420 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010421 Value *Idx[2];
10422 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10423 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010424 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10425 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010426
10427 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10428 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010429 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010430 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10431 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010432 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010433 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010434
10435 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10436 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10437 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010438 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010439 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010440 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10441
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010442 return 0;
10443}
10444
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010445Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10446 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10447
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010448 // free undef -> unreachable.
10449 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10450 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010451 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010452 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010453 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10454 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010455
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010456 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10457 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010458 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010459 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010460
10461 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10462 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10463 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10464 return &FI;
10465 }
10466
10467 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10468 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10469 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10470 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10471 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10472 return &FI;
10473 }
10474 }
10475
10476 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10477 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10478 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10479 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10480 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10481 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010482
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010483 return 0;
10484}
10485
10486
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010487/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010488static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010489 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010490 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010491 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010492
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010493 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10494 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10495 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010496 std::string Str;
10497 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010498 unsigned len = Str.length();
10499 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10500 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10501 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10502 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010503 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10504 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10505 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10506 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10507 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10508 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10509 }
10510 } else {
10511 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10512 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10513 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10514 }
10515 // Append NULL at the end.
10516 SingleChar = 0;
10517 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10518 }
10519 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10520 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010521 }
10522 }
10523 }
10524
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010525 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010526 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010527 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010528
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010529 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010530 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010531 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10532 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10533 // constants.
10534 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10535 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10536 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010537 Value *Idxs[2];
10538 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10539 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010540 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10541 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10542 }
10543
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010544 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010545 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010546 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10547 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10548 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010549 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10550 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010551
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010552 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10553 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10554 // the result of the loaded value.
10555 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10556 CI->getName(),
10557 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10558 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010559 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010560 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010561 }
10562 }
10563 return 0;
10564}
10565
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010566/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010567/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10568/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10569/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10570static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010571 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10572 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10573
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010574 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010575 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010576 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010577 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010578
10579 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10580 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010581 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10582 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10583 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010584 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10585
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010586 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010587 --BBI;
10588
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010589 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10590 // marked invalid.
10591 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10592 return false;
10593
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010594 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10595 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010596 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010597 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010598 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010599
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010600 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010601 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010602}
10603
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10605 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010606
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010607 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010608 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10609 if (KnownAlign >
10610 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10611 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010612 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10613
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010614 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010615 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010616 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010617 return Res;
10618
10619 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10620 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010621
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010622 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10623 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010624 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10625 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010626 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10627 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010629 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10630 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010632 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010633
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010634 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10635 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10636 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10637 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10638 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010639 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10640 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10641 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10642 // CFG.
10643 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10644 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10646 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010647 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010648
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010649 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010650 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010651 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10652 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10653 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010654 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10655 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10656 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010657 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10658 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010660 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010661
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010662 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10663 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010664 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010666
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010667 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010668 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010669 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10670 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010671 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010672 if (Constant *V =
10673 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010675 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10676 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10677 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10678 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10679 // CFG.
10680 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10681 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10683 }
10684
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010685 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010686 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010687 return Res;
10688 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010689 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010690 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010691
10692 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10693 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010694 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010695 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10696 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10698 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10700 }
10701 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010702
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010703 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010704 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10705 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10706 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10707 //
10708 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10709 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10710 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10711 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10712 // unconditionally.
10713 //
10714 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10715 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010716 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10717 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010718 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010719 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010720 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010721 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010722 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010723 }
10724
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010725 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10726 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10727 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10728 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10729 return &LI;
10730 }
10731
10732 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10733 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10734 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10735 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10736 return &LI;
10737 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010738 }
10739 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010740 return 0;
10741}
10742
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010743/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010744/// when possible.
10745static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10746 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10747 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10748
10749 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10750 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10751 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10752
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010753 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010754 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10755 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10756 // constants.
10757 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10758 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10759 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010760 Value* Idxs[2];
10761 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10762 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010763 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10764 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10765 }
10766
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010767 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10768 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10769 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010770
10771 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010772 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10773 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010774 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010775 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010776 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10777 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10778 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10779 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10780 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010781 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010782 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010783 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010784 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10785 }
10786 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010787 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010788 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010789 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010790 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010791 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010792 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10793 }
10794 }
10795 }
10796 return 0;
10797}
10798
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010799Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10800 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10801 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10802
10803 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010804 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010805 ++NumCombined;
10806 return 0;
10807 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010808
10809 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10810 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010811 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010812 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10813 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10814 ++NumCombined;
10815 return 0;
10816 }
10817
10818 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10819 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10820 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10821 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10822 ++NumCombined;
10823 return 0;
10824 }
10825 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010826
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010827 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010828 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10829 if (KnownAlign >
10830 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10831 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010832 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10833
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010834 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10835 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10836 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10837 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10838 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10839 --ScanInsts) {
10840 --BBI;
10841
10842 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10843 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10844 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10845 ++NumDeadStore;
10846 ++BBI;
10847 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10848 continue;
10849 }
10850 break;
10851 }
10852
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010853 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10854 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10855 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10856 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010857 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010858 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10859 ++NumCombined;
10860 return 0;
10861 }
10862 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10863 // may not be dead.
10864 break;
10865 }
10866
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010867 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010868 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010869 break;
10870 }
10871
10872
10873 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010874
10875 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10876 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10877 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10878 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10879 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010880 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010881 ++NumCombined;
10882 }
10883 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10884 }
10885
10886 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10887 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010888 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010889 ++NumCombined;
10890 return 0;
10891 }
10892
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010893 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10894 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010895 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010896 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10897 return Res;
10898 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010899 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010900 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10901 return Res;
10902
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010903
10904 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10905 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010906 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010907 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010908 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10909 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10910 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010911
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010912 return 0;
10913}
10914
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010915/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10916/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10917/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10918///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010919/// Simplify things like:
10920/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10921/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10922///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010923bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10924 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10925
10926 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10927 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10928 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010929 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010930
10931 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10932 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010933 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10934 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010935 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010936 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010937 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010938 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010939 return false;
10940
10941 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010942 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010943 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010944 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010945 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010946 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010947 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010948
10949 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10950 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10951 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10952 return false;
10953
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010954 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10955 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010956 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010957 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010958 return false;
10959
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010960 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10961 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10962 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10963 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10964 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10965 --BBI;
10966 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10967 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10968 return false;
10969 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010970 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010971 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10972 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10973 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10974 return false;
10975
10976 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010977 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10978 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010979 for (;; --BBI) {
10980 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10981 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10982 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10983 return false;
10984 break;
10985 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010986 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10987 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10988 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010989 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10990 return false;
10991 }
10992
10993 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010994 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10995 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010996 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10997 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010998 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010999 return false;
11000 }
11001 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011002
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011003 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011004 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11005 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011006 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011007 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11008 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011009 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11010 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011011 }
11012
11013 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11014 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011015 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011016 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11017 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11018
11019 // Nuke the old stores.
11020 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11021 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11022 ++NumCombined;
11023 return true;
11024}
11025
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011026
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011027Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11028 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011029 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011030 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11031 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11032 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11033 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11034 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11035 BI.setCondition(X);
11036 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11037 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11038 return &BI;
11039 }
11040
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011041 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11042 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11043 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11044 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11045 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11046 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11047 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011048 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011049 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11050 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011051 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11052 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11053 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11054 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011055 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011056 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011057 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011058 return &BI;
11059 }
11060
11061 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11062 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11063 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11064 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11065 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11066 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11067 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11068 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011069 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011070 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11071 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011072 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011073 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011074 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11075 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011076 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011077 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011078 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011079 return &BI;
11080 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011081
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011082 return 0;
11083}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011084
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011085Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11086 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11087 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11088 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11089 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11090 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11091 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011092 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011093 AddRHS));
11094 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011095 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011096 return &SI;
11097 }
11098 }
11099 return 0;
11100}
11101
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011102Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011103 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011104
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011105 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11106 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11107
11108 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11109 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11111
11112 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11113 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11114
11115 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11116 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11117 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11118 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11119 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11120 // first index
11121 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11122 else
11123 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11124 }
11125 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11126 }
11127 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11128 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11129 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11130 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11131 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11132 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11133 ++exti, ++insi) {
11134 if (*insi != *exti)
11135 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11136 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11137 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11138 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11139 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11140 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11141 // with
11142 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11143 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11144 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11145 }
11146 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11147 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11148 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11149 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11150 // with "i32 42"
11151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11152 if (exti == exte) {
11153 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11154 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11155 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11156 // with
11157 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11158 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11159 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11160 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11161 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11162 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11163 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11164 EV);
11165 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11166 insi, inse);
11167 }
11168 if (insi == inse)
11169 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11170 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11171 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11172 // i.e., replace
11173 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11174 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11175 // with
11176 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11177 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11178 exti, exte);
11179 }
11180 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11181 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11182 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11183 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011184 return 0;
11185}
11186
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011187/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11188/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11189static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11190 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11191 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011192 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011193 if (isConstant) return true;
11194 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11195 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11196 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11197 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11198 return false;
11199 return true;
11200 }
11201 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11202 if (!I) return false;
11203
11204 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11205 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11206 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11207 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11208 return true;
11209 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11210 return true;
11211 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11212 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11213 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11214 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11215 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011216 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11217 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11218 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11219 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11220 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011221
11222 return false;
11223}
11224
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011225/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11226///
11227/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11228/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011229static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11230 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11231 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11232 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11233 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11234 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11235
11236 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011237 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011238 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11239 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011240 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11241 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011242 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011243 return Result;
11244}
11245
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011246/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11247/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11248/// extracted from the vector.
11249static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011250 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11251 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011252 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11253 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011254 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11255
11256 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11257 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11258 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11259 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011260 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011261 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11262 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11263 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011264 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11265 return 0;
11266 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011267
11268 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11269 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011270 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11271 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011272
11273 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11274 // vector input.
11275 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011276 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011277 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
11278 if (InEl < Width)
11279 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
11280 else if (InEl < Width*2)
11281 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
11282 else
11283 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011284 }
11285
11286 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11287 return 0;
11288}
11289
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011290Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011291 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011292 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11294
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011295 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011296 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11298
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011299 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011300 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11301 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11302 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011303 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011304 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011305 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11306 op0 = 0;
11307 break;
11308 }
11309 if (op0)
11310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011311 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011312
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011313 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11314 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011315 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011316 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11317 unsigned VectorWidth =
11318 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11319
11320 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11321 // crashing the code below.
11322 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11324
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011325 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11326 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11327 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011328 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011329 uint64_t UndefElts;
11330 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011331 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011332 UndefElts)) {
11333 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11334 return &EI;
11335 }
11336 }
11337
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011338 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011339 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011340
11341 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11342 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11343 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11344 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11345 if (const VectorType *VT =
11346 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11347 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11348 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11349 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11350 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011351 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011352
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011353 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011354 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11355 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11356 // profitable to do so
11357 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011358 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11359 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11360 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11361 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11362 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11363 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11364 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11365 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11366 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11367 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011368 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011369 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011370 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011371 unsigned AS =
11372 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011373 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11374 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011375 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11376 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011377 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11378 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011379 }
11380 }
11381 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11382 // Extracting the inserted element?
11383 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11385 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11386 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11387 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11388 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11389 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11390 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11391 return &EI;
11392 }
11393 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11394 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11395 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011396 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11397 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011398 Value *Src;
11399 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11400 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11401 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11402 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11403 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11404 } else {
11405 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011406 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011407 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011408 }
11409 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011410 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011411 return 0;
11412}
11413
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011414/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11415/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11416/// Otherwise, return false.
11417static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11418 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11419 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11420 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011421 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011422
11423 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011424 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011425 return true;
11426 } else if (V == LHS) {
11427 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011428 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011429 return true;
11430 } else if (V == RHS) {
11431 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011432 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011433 return true;
11434 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11435 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11436 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11437 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11438 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11439
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011440 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11441 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011442 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011443
11444 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11445 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11446 // transitively ok.
11447 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11448 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011449 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011450 return true;
11451 }
11452 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11453 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011454 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11455 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011456 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011457
11458 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11459 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11460 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11461 // transitively ok.
11462 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11463 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11464 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011465 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011466 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011467 } else {
11468 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011469 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011470 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011471
11472 }
11473 return true;
11474 }
11475 }
11476 }
11477 }
11478 }
11479 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11480
11481 return false;
11482}
11483
11484/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11485/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11486/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011487static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011488 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011489 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011490 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011491 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011492 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011493
11494 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011495 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011496 return V;
11497 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011498 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011499 return V;
11500 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11501 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11502 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11503 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11504 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11505
11506 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11507 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11508 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11509 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011510 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11511 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011512
11513 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11514 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011515 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11516 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11517 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011518 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011519 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011520 return V;
11521 }
11522
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011523 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11524 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011525 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11526 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11527 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011528 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011529 }
11530 return V;
11531 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011532
11533 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11534 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11535 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11536 return EI->getOperand(0);
11537
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011538 }
11539 }
11540 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011541 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011542
11543 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11544 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011545 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011546 return V;
11547}
11548
11549Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11550 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11551 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11552 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11553
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011554 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11555 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11556 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11557
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011558 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11559 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11560 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11561 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11562 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11563 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011564 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11565 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011566 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011567
11568 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11569 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11570
11571 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11572 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11573
11574 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11575 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11576 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11578
11579 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11580 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11581 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11582 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11583 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11584 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11585 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11586 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11587 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11588 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011589 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011590 else {
11591 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011592 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011593 NumVectorElts));
11594 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011595 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011596 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011597 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011598 }
11599
11600 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11601 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11602 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11603 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011604 Value *RHS = 0;
11605 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11606 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11607 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011608 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011609 }
11610 }
11611 }
11612
11613 return 0;
11614}
11615
11616
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011617Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11618 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11619 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011620 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011621
11622 bool MadeChange = false;
11623
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011624 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011625 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011626 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011627
11628 uint64_t UndefElts;
11629 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
11630 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11631 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011632 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11633 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11634 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011635 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011636 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011637
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011638 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11639 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11640 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11641 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011642 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11644 }
11645
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011646 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11647 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11648 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011649 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011650 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011651 else {
11652 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011653 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011654 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011655 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11656 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011657 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011658 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11659 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011660 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011661 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011662 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011663 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011664 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011665 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11666 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011667 MadeChange = true;
11668 }
11669
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011670 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011671 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011672
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011673 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11674 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11675 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11676 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11677
11678 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11679 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011680 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011681
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011682 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11683 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11684 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011685
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011686 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11687 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11688 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11689 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11690 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11691 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11692 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11693 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11694 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11695 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11696 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11697 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11698
11699 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11700 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11701 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11702 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11703 else
11704 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11705
11706 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11707 // the replacement.
11708 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11709 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11710 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11711 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011712 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011713 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011714 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011715 }
11716 }
11717 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11718 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011719 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011720 }
11721 }
11722 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011723
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011724 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11725}
11726
11727
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011728
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011729
11730/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11731/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11732/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11733/// end of its block.
11734static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11735 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11736
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011737 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011738 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11739 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011740
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011741 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011742 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11743 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011744 return false;
11745
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011746 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11747 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011748 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11749 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011750 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11751 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11752 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011753 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011754
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011755 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011756
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011757 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011758 ++NumSunkInst;
11759 return true;
11760}
11761
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011762
11763/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11764/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11765///
11766/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11767/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11768/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11769/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11770/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11771///
11772static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011773 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011774 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011775 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011776 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011777 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011778
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011779 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11780 BB = Worklist.back();
11781 Worklist.pop_back();
11782
11783 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11784 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11785
11786 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11787 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011788
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011789 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11790 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11791 ++NumDeadInst;
11792 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11793 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11794 continue;
11795 }
11796
11797 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11798 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11799 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11800 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11801 ++NumConstProp;
11802 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11803 continue;
11804 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011805
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011806 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011807 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011808
11809 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11810 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11811 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11812 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11813 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11814 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011815 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011816 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011817 continue;
11818 }
11819 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11820 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11821 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11822 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11823 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011824 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011825 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011826 continue;
11827 }
11828
11829 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11830 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11831 continue;
11832 }
11833 }
11834
11835 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11836 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011837 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011838}
11839
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011840bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011841 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011842 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011843
11844 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11845 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011846
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011847 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011848 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11849 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11850 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011851 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011852 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011853
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011854 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11855 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11856 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11857 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11858 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11859 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11860 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11861 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011862
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011863 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011864 ++NumDeadInst;
11865
11866 if (!I->use_empty())
11867 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11868 I->eraseFromParent();
11869 }
11870 }
11871 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011872
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011873 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11874 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11875 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011876
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011877 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011878 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011879 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011880 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011881 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011882 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011883
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011884 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011885
11886 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011887 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011888 continue;
11889 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011890
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011891 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011892 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011893 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011894
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011895 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011896 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011897 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11898
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011899 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011900 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011901 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011902 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011903 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011904
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011905 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11906 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11907 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11908 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11909 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11910 i->set(NewC);
11911 }
11912 }
11913 }
11914
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011915 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011916 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011917 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11918 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11919 if (UserParent != BB) {
11920 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11921 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11922 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11923 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11924 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11925 break;
11926 }
11927
11928 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11929 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11930 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11931 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11932 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11933 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11934 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11935 }
11936 }
11937
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011938 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011939#ifndef NDEBUG
11940 std::string OrigI;
11941#endif
11942 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011943 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011944 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011945 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011946 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011947 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11948 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011949
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011950 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11951 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11952
11953 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011954 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011955 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011956
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011957 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11958 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011959
11960 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11961 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011962 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11963
11964 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11965 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11966 ++InsertPos;
11967
11968 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011969
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011970 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11971 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011972 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011973
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011974 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11975 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011976 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011977
11978 // Erase the old instruction.
11979 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011980 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011981#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011982 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11983 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011984#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011985
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011986 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11987 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011988 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11989 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11990 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011991 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011992
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011993 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011994 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011995 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011996 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011997 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011998 AddToWorkList(I);
11999 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012000 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012001 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012002 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012003 }
12004 }
12005
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012006 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012007
12008 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12009 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012010 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012011}
12012
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012013
12014bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012015 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12016
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012017 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12018
12019 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12020 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012021 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012022 EverMadeChange = true;
12023 return EverMadeChange;
12024}
12025
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012026FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012027 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012028}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012029
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012030